blob: 227b50f6b885778ea2df28b0b8b7546c35e5e639 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau16216822012-09-10 09:46:55 +02007 2012/09/10
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +0100565. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020057
586. HTTP header manipulation
59
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100607. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200617.1. Matching integers
627.2. Matching strings
637.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +0200647.4. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200657.5. Available matching criteria
667.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
677.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4
687.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
697.6. Pre-defined ACLs
707.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100717.8. Pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020072
738. Logging
748.1. Log levels
758.2. Log formats
768.2.1. Default log format
778.2.2. TCP log format
788.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100798.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200808.3. Advanced logging options
818.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
828.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
838.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
848.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
858.4. Timing events
868.5. Session state at disconnection
878.6. Non-printable characters
888.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
898.8. Capturing HTTP headers
908.9. Examples of logs
91
929. Statistics and monitoring
939.1. CSV format
949.2. Unix Socket commands
95
96
971. Quick reminder about HTTP
98----------------------------
99
100When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
101fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
102on almost anything found in the contents.
103
104However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
105formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
106correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
107
108
1091.1. The HTTP transaction model
110-------------------------------
111
112The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100113to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200114from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
115connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
116will involve a new connection :
117
118 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
119
120In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
121establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
122by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
123length.
124
125Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
126to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
127however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
128response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
129header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
130
131 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
132
133Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
134power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
135but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200136a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137
138A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
139keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
140second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
141page :
142
143 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
144
145This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
146latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
147correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
148the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100149server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200151By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
152connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
153everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
154established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
155sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
156while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
157another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
158sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
159http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
160mode.
161
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200162
1631.2. HTTP request
164-----------------
165
166First, let's consider this HTTP request :
167
168 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100169 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
171 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
172 3 User-agent: my small browser
173 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
174 5 Accept: image/png
175
176
1771.2.1. The Request line
178-----------------------
179
180Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
181
182 - a METHOD : GET
183 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
184 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
185
186All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
187which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
188followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
189is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
190desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
191the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
192
193The URI itself can have several forms :
194
195 - A "relative URI" :
196
197 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
198
199 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
200 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
201
202 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
203
204 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
205
206 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
207 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
208 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
209 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
210 must accept this form too.
211
212 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
213 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
214 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100215
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200216 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
217 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
218 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
219 other protocols too.
220
221In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
222mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
223on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
224It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
225specific to the language, framework or application in use.
226
227
2281.2.2. The request headers
229--------------------------
230
231The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
232beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
233an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
234Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
235values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
236encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
237the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
238define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
239
240Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
241their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
242"Connection:" header).
243
244The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
245that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
246is one valid form of empty line.
247
248Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
249headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
250about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
251application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
252
253Important note:
254 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
255 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
256 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
257 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
258
259
2601.3. HTTP response
261------------------
262
263An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
264messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
265
266 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100267 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200268 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
269 2 Content-length: 350
270 3 Content-Type: text/html
271
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200272As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
273codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
274response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100275continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
276the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
277following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
278sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
279(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
280correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
281such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
282state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
283over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
284if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
285information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200286
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200287
2881.3.1. The Response line
289------------------------
290
291Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
292
293 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
294 - a status code : 200
295 - a reason : OK
296
297The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200298 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
300 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
301 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
302 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
303
304Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100305"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200306found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
307messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
308or "Authentication Required".
309
310Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
311
312 Code When / reason
313 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
314 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
315 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
316 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
317 400 for an invalid or too large request
318 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
319 accessing the stats page)
320 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
321 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
322 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
323 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
324 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
325 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
326 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
327 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
328 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
329
330The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3314.2).
332
333
3341.3.2. The response headers
335---------------------------
336
337Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
338the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
339details.
340
341
3422. Configuring HAProxy
343----------------------
344
3452.1. Configuration file format
346------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200347
348HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
349
350 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
351 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
352 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
353 "frontend" and "backend".
354
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100355The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
356referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
357delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100358preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100359escaped by doubling them.
360
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200361
3622.2. Time format
363----------------
364
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100365Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100366values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
367otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
368numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
369for every keyword. Supported units are :
370
371 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
372 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
373 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
374 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
375 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
376 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
377
378
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003792.3. Examples
380-------------
381
382 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
383 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
384 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
385 global
386 daemon
387 maxconn 256
388
389 defaults
390 mode http
391 timeout connect 5000ms
392 timeout client 50000ms
393 timeout server 50000ms
394
395 frontend http-in
396 bind *:80
397 default_backend servers
398
399 backend servers
400 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
401
402
403 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
404 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
405 global
406 daemon
407 maxconn 256
408
409 defaults
410 mode http
411 timeout connect 5000ms
412 timeout client 50000ms
413 timeout server 50000ms
414
415 listen http-in
416 bind *:80
417 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
418
419
420Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
421
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100422 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200423
424
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004253. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200426--------------------
427
428Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
429are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
430of them have command-line equivalents.
431
432The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
433
434 * Process management and security
435 - chroot
436 - daemon
437 - gid
438 - group
439 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100440 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200441 - nbproc
442 - pidfile
443 - uid
444 - ulimit-n
445 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200446 - stats
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200447 - node
448 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100449 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100450
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200451 * Performance tuning
452 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200453 - maxconnrate
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100454 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200455 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200456 - noepoll
457 - nokqueue
458 - nopoll
459 - nosepoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100460 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200461 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200462 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200463 - tune.chksize
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200464 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100465 - tune.maxaccept
466 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200467 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200468 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100469 - tune.rcvbuf.client
470 - tune.rcvbuf.server
471 - tune.sndbuf.client
472 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100473
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200474 * Debugging
475 - debug
476 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200477
478
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004793.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200480------------------------------------
481
482chroot <jail dir>
483 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
484 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
485 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
486 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
487 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
488 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100489
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200490daemon
491 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
492 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
493 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
494
495gid <number>
496 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
497 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
498 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
499 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100500
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200501group <group name>
502 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
503 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100504
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200505log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200506 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
507 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100508 configured with "log global".
509
510 <address> can be one of:
511
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100512 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100513 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
514 port).
515
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100516 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
517 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
518 port).
519
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100520 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
521 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
522 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
523 writeable).
524
525 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200526
527 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
528 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
529 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
530
531 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200532 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
533 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
534 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
535 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
536 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
537 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200538
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200539 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200540
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100541log-send-hostname [<string>]
542 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
543 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
544 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
545 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
546 the logs.
547
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000548log-tag <string>
549 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
550 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
551 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
552 running on the same host.
553
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200554nbproc <number>
555 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
556 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
557 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
558 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
559 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
560
561pidfile <pidfile>
562 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
563 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
564 starting the process. See also "daemon".
565
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200566stats socket <path> [{uid | user} <uid>] [{gid | group} <gid>] [mode <mode>]
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200567 [level <level>]
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200568
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200569 Creates a UNIX socket in stream mode at location <path>. Any previously
570 existing socket will be backed up then replaced. Connections to this socket
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100571 will return various statistics outputs and even allow some commands to be
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200572 issued. Please consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
573
574 An optional "level" parameter can be specified to restrict the nature of
575 the commands that can be issued on the socket :
576 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
577 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
578 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
579
580 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +0200581 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200582 counters).
583
584 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
585 all counters).
Willy Tarreaua8efd362008-01-03 10:19:15 +0100586
587 On platforms which support it, it is possible to restrict access to this
588 socket by specifying numerical IDs after "uid" and "gid", or valid user and
589 group names after the "user" and "group" keywords. It is also possible to
590 restrict permissions on the socket by passing an octal value after the "mode"
591 keyword (same syntax as chmod). Depending on the platform, the permissions on
592 the socket will be inherited from the directory which hosts it, or from the
593 user the process is started with.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200594
595stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
596 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
597 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100598 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200599
600stats maxconn <connections>
601 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
602 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
603
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200604uid <number>
605 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
606 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
607 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
608 one. See also "gid" and "user".
609
610ulimit-n <number>
611 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
612 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
613 option.
614
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100615unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
616 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
617
618 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
619 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
620 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
621 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
622 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
623 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
624 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
625 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
626 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
627 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
628
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200629user <user name>
630 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
631 See also "uid" and "group".
632
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200633node <name>
634 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
635
636 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
637 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
638 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
639 traffic.
640
641description <text>
642 Add a text that describes the instance.
643
644 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
645 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
646 "<" and ">" characters.
647
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200648
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006493.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200650-----------------------
651
652maxconn <number>
653 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
654 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
655 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
656 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
657
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200658maxconnrate <number>
659 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
660 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
661 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
662 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
663 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
664 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
665 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
666 fairness.
667
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100668maxpipes <number>
669 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
670 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
671 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
672 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
673 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
674 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
675
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200676maxsslconn <number>
677 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
678 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
679 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
680 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
681 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
682 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
683 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
684
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200685noepoll
686 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
687 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
688 used will generally be "poll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
689
690nokqueue
691 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
692 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
693 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
694
695nopoll
696 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
697 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100698 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200699 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll" and
700 "nokqueue".
701
702nosepoll
703 Disables the use of the "speculative epoll" event polling system on Linux. It
704 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-ds". The next polling system
705 used will generally be "epoll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
706
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100707nosplice
708 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
709 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
710 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100711 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100712 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
713 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
714 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
715 "option splice-response".
716
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200717spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
718 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending health checks to servers at exact
719 intervals, for instance when many logical servers are located on the same
720 physical server. With the help of this parameter, it becomes possible to add
721 some randomness in the check interval between 0 and +/- 50%. A value between
722 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The default value remains at 0.
723
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200724tune.bufsize <number>
725 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
726 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
727 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
728 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
729 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
730 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
731 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
732 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
733
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200734tune.chksize <number>
735 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
736 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
737 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
738 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
739 checks whenever possible.
740
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200741tune.http.maxhdr <number>
742 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
743 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
744 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
745 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
746 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
747 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
748 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
749 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
750 limit too high.
751
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100752tune.maxaccept <number>
753 Sets the maximum number of consecutive accepts that a process may perform on
754 a single wake up. High values give higher priority to high connection rates,
755 while lower values give higher priority to already established connections.
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100756 This value is limited to 100 by default in single process mode. However, in
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100757 multi-process mode (nbproc > 1), it defaults to 8 so that when one process
758 wakes up, it does not take all incoming connections for itself and leaves a
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100759 part of them to other processes. Setting this value to -1 completely disables
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100760 the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
761
762tune.maxpollevents <number>
763 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
764 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
765 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
766 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
767 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
768
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200769tune.maxrewrite <number>
770 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
771 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
772 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
773 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
774 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
775 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
776 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
777 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
778 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
779 bufsize.
780
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200781tune.pipesize <number>
782 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
783 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
784 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
785 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
786 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
787 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
788
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100789tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
790tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
791 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
792 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
793 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
794 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
795 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
796 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
797 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
798
799tune.sndbuf.client <number>
800tune.sndbuf.server <number>
801 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
802 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
803 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
804 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
805 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
806 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
807 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
808 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
809 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
810 notifying haproxy again.
811
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200812
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008133.3. Debugging
814--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200815
816debug
817 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
818 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
819 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
820 system startup.
821
822quiet
823 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
824 line argument "-q".
825
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200826
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008273.4. Userlists
828--------------
829It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
830http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
831it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
832
833userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100834 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100835 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
836
837group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100838 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100839 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
840 proceeded by "users" keyword.
841
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100842user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
843 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100844 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
845 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100846 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
847 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100848 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
849 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
850
851
852 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100853 userlist L1
854 group G1 users tiger,scott
855 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100856
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100857 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
858 user scott insecure-password elgato
859 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100860
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100861 userlist L2
862 group G1
863 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100864
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100865 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
866 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
867 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100868
869 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200870
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200871
8723.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200873----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200874It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
875haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
876pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
877identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
878or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
879Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
880known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
881the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
882process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
883during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
884tables.
885
886peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -0400887 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200888 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
889
890peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
891 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
892 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
893 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
894 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
895 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
896 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
897
898 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
899 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
900
901 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
902 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
903 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
904 across all peers.
905
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200906 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200907 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100908 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
909 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
910 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200911
912 backend mybackend
913 mode tcp
914 balance roundrobin
915 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
916 stick on src
917
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100918 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
919 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200920
921
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009224. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200923----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100924
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200925Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
926 - defaults <name>
927 - frontend <name>
928 - backend <name>
929 - listen <name>
930
931A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
932its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
933section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100934section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200935
936A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
937connections.
938
939A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
940to forward incoming connections.
941
942A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
943parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
944
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100945All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
946'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
947case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
948
949Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
950logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
951proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
952However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
953name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
954
955Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
956and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100957bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100958protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
959modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
960arbitrary criteria.
961
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100962
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009634.1. Proxy keywords matrix
964--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100965
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200966The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
967limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
968they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
969limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100970marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200971option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +0200972and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
973with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
974specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100975
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200976
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100977 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
978------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
979acl - X X X
980appsession - - X X
981backlog X X X -
982balance X - X X
983bind - X X -
984bind-process X X X X
985block - X X X
986capture cookie - X X -
987capture request header - X X -
988capture response header - X X -
989clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
990contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
991cookie X - X X
992default-server X - X X
993default_backend X X X -
994description - X X X
995disabled X X X X
996dispatch - - X X
997enabled X X X X
998errorfile X X X X
999errorloc X X X X
1000errorloc302 X X X X
1001-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1002errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001003force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001004fullconn X - X X
1005grace X X X X
1006hash-type X - X X
1007http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001008http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001009http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001010http-request - X X X
1011id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001012ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001013log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001014maxconn X X X -
1015mode X X X X
1016monitor fail - X X -
1017monitor-net X X X -
1018monitor-uri X X X -
1019option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1020option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1021option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1022option allbackups (*) X - X X
1023option checkcache (*) X - X X
1024option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1025option contstats (*) X X X -
1026option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1027option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1028option forceclose (*) X X X X
1029-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1030option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001031option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001032option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001033option http-server-close (*) X X X X
1034option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1035option httpchk X - X X
1036option httpclose (*) X X X X
1037option httplog X X X X
1038option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001039option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001040option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001041option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1042option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1043option logasap (*) X X X -
1044option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001045option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001046option nolinger (*) X X X X
1047option originalto X X X X
1048option persist (*) X - X X
1049option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001050option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001051option smtpchk X - X X
1052option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1053option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1054option splice-request (*) X X X X
1055option splice-response (*) X X X X
1056option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1057option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1058-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1059option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1060option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1061option tcpka X X X X
1062option tcplog X X X X
1063option transparent (*) X - X X
1064persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1065rate-limit sessions X X X -
1066redirect - X X X
1067redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1068redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1069reqadd - X X X
1070reqallow - X X X
1071reqdel - X X X
1072reqdeny - X X X
1073reqiallow - X X X
1074reqidel - X X X
1075reqideny - X X X
1076reqipass - X X X
1077reqirep - X X X
1078reqisetbe - X X X
1079reqitarpit - X X X
1080reqpass - X X X
1081reqrep - X X X
1082-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1083reqsetbe - X X X
1084reqtarpit - X X X
1085retries X - X X
1086rspadd - X X X
1087rspdel - X X X
1088rspdeny - X X X
1089rspidel - X X X
1090rspideny - X X X
1091rspirep - X X X
1092rsprep - X X X
1093server - - X X
1094source X - X X
1095srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001096stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001097stats auth X - X X
1098stats enable X - X X
1099stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001100stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001101stats realm X - X X
1102stats refresh X - X X
1103stats scope X - X X
1104stats show-desc X - X X
1105stats show-legends X - X X
1106stats show-node X - X X
1107stats uri X - X X
1108-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1109stick match - - X X
1110stick on - - X X
1111stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001112stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001113stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001114tcp-request connection - X X -
1115tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001116tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001117tcp-response content - - X X
1118tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001119timeout check X - X X
1120timeout client X X X -
1121timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1122timeout connect X - X X
1123timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1124timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1125timeout http-request X X X X
1126timeout queue X - X X
1127timeout server X - X X
1128timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1129timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001130timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001131transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001132unique-id-format X X X -
1133unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001134use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001135use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001136------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1137 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001138
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001139
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011404.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1141---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001142
1143This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1144
1145
1146acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1147 Declare or complete an access list.
1148 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1149 no | yes | yes | yes
1150 Example:
1151 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1152 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1153 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1154
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001155 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001156
1157
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001158appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1159 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001160 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1161 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1162 no | no | yes | yes
1163 Arguments :
1164 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1165 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1166
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001167 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001168 checked in each cookie value.
1169
1170 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1171 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1172 milliseconds.
1173
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001174 request-learn
1175 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1176 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1177 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1178 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1179 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1180 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1181
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001182 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1183 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1184 data following this prefix.
1185
1186 Example :
1187 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1188
1189 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1190 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1191
1192 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1193 2 modes are currently supported :
1194 - path-parameters :
1195 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1196 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1197 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1198 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1199 - query-string :
1200 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1201 query string.
1202
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001203 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1204 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1205 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1206 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001207 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1208 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1209 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001210 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1211 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1212
1213 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1214
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001215 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1216 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1217 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1218
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001219 Example :
1220 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1221
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001222 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1223 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001224
1225
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001226backlog <conns>
1227 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1228 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1229 yes | yes | yes | no
1230 Arguments :
1231 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1232 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001233 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001234
1235 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1236 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1237 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1238 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1239 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1240 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1241 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1242 backlog parameter.
1243
1244 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1245 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1246 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1247
1248 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1249
1250
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001251balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001252balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001253 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1254 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1255 yes | no | yes | yes
1256 Arguments :
1257 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1258 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1259 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1260 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1261
1262 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1263 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1264 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1265 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001266 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
1267 design to 4128 active servers per backend. Note that in some
1268 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1269 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1270 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1271 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1272 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1273 it, so that you don't worry.
1274
1275 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1276 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1277 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1278 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1279 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1280 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1281 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1282 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001283
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001284 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1285 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1286 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1287 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1288 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1289 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1290 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1291 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1292
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001293 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
1294 connection. The servers are choosen from the lowest numeric
1295 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1296 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001297 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001298 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1299 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1300 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1301 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1302 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001303 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1304 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1305 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1306 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1307 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1308 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001309
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001310 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1311 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1312 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1313 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1314 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1315 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1316 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1317 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001318 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001319 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001320 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1321 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1322 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001323
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001324 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1325 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1326 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1327 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1328 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1329 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1330 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1331 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1332 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1333 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1334 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1335 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001336
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001337 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001338 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1339 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1340 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1341 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1342 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1343 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1344 URIs start with a leading "/".
1345
1346 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1347 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1348 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1349 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1350
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001351 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001352 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1353
1354 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001355 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1356 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
1357 ('?') in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
1358 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1359 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1360 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1361 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1362 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1363 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1364 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1365 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1366 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1367 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1368 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1369 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1370 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1371 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1372 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1373 be randomly balanced if at all.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001374
1375 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1376 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1377 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1378 server will receive the request.
1379
1380 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1381 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1382 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1383 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1384 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001385 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1386 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1387 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001388
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001389 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1390 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1391 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1392 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1393 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001394
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001395 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001396 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1397 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1398 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1399
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001400 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1401 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1402 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1403
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001404 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001405 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001406 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1407 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1408 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1409 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1410 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1411 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001412 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001413 used instead.
1414
1415 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1416 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1417 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1418 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1419
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001420 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1421 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1422 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1423
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001424 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001425
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001426 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001427 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1428 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001429
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001430 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001431 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001432
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001433 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1434 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1435 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001436
1437 Examples :
1438 balance roundrobin
1439 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001440 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001441 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1442 balance hdr(host)
1443 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001444
1445 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1446 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1447
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001448 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001449 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1450 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1451 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1452 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1453
1454 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1455 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1456 defaults to 16 kB.
1457
1458 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1459 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1460
1461 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1462 Round Robin.
1463
1464 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1465 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1466 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1467 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1468
1469 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1470
1471 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001472 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001473 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1474 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1475 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001476
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001477 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1478 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001479
1480
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001481bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...]
1482bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] interface <interface>
1483bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] mss <maxseg>
Willy Tarreau32368ce2012-09-06 11:10:55 +02001484bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] backlog <backlog>
1485bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreau50acaaa2012-09-06 14:26:36 +02001486bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] nice <nice>
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001487bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] transparent
1488bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] id <id>
1489bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] name <name>
1490bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] defer-accept
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001491bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] ssl
1492bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] crt <cert>
1493bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] ciphers <ciphers>
1494bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] nosslv3
1495bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] notlsv1
1496bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] prefer-server-ciphers
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001497bind /<path> [, ...]
1498bind /<path> [, ...] mode <mode>
1499bind /<path> [, ...] [ user <user> | uid <uid> ]
1500bind /<path> [, ...] [ group <user> | gid <gid> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001501 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1502 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1503 no | yes | yes | no
1504 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001505 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1506 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1507 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1508 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001509 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001510
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001511 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1512 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001513 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1514 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1515 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001516 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1517 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1518 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1519 the range.
1520
1521 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1522 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1523 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1524 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1525 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1526 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1527 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001528 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001529 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001530
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001531 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1532 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1533 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1534 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1535 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1536 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1537 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1538 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1539
Willy Tarreau5e6e2042009-02-04 17:19:29 +01001540 <interface> is an optional physical interface name. This is currently
1541 only supported on Linux. The interface must be a physical
1542 interface, not an aliased interface. When specified, all
1543 addresses on the same line will only be accepted if the
1544 incoming packet physically come through the designated
1545 interface. It is also possible to bind multiple frontends to
1546 the same address if they are bound to different interfaces.
1547 Note that binding to a physical interface requires root
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001548 privileges. This parameter is only compatible with TCP
1549 sockets.
Willy Tarreau5e6e2042009-02-04 17:19:29 +01001550
Willy Tarreaube1b9182009-06-14 18:48:19 +02001551 <maxseg> is an optional TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be
1552 advertised on incoming connections. This can be used to force
1553 a lower MSS for certain specific ports, for instance for
1554 connections passing through a VPN. Note that this relies on a
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001555 kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux
1556 but was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may
1557 not work on other operating systems. It may also not change
1558 the advertised value but change the effective size of
1559 outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value on Ethernet
1560 networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
1561 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is
1562 negative, it will indicate by how much to reduce the incoming
1563 connection's advertised MSS for outgoing segments. This
1564 parameter is only compatible with TCP sockets.
Willy Tarreaube1b9182009-06-14 18:48:19 +02001565
Willy Tarreau32368ce2012-09-06 11:10:55 +02001566 <backlog> sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the
1567 frontend's backlog is used instead.
1568
1569 <maxconn> limits the socket to this number of concurrent connections.
1570 Extra connections will remain in the system's backlog until a
1571 connection is released. If unspecified, the limit will be the
1572 same as the frontend's maxconn. Note that in case of port
1573 ranges, the same value will be applied to each socket. This
1574 setting enables different limitations on expensive sockets,
1575 for instance SSL entries which may easily eat all memory.
1576
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02001577 <id> is a persistent value for socket ID. Must be positive and
1578 unique in the proxy. An unused value will automatically be
1579 assigned if unset. Can only be used when defining only a
1580 single socket.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02001581
Willy Tarreau50acaaa2012-09-06 14:26:36 +02001582 <nice> sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket.
1583 Value must be in the range -1024..1024, and default is zero.
1584 Positive values means that such connections are more friendly
1585 to others and easily offer their place in the scheduler. On
1586 the opposite, negative values mean that connections want to
1587 run with a higher priority. The difference only happens under
1588 high loads when the system is close to saturation. Negative
1589 values are appropriate for low-latency or admin services, and
1590 high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks
1591 such as SSL processing which are less sensible to latency.
1592
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02001593 <name> is an optional name provided for stats
1594
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001595 <mode> is the octal mode used to define access permissions on the
1596 UNIX socket. It can also be set by default in the global
1597 section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms
1598 simply ignore this.
1599
1600 <user> is the name of user that will be marked owner of the UNIX
1601 socket. It can also be set by default in the global
1602 section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms
1603 simply ignore this.
1604
1605 <group> is the name of a group that will be used to create the UNIX
1606 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1607 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1608 this.
1609
1610 <uid> is the uid of user that will be marked owner of the UNIX
1611 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1612 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1613 this.
1614
1615 <gid> is the gid of a group that will be used to create the UNIX
1616 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1617 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1618 this.
1619
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001620 <cert> designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate
1621 and the assocaited private key. This file can be build by
1622 concatenating both PEM files into one. If a directory name is
1623 used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in that
1624 directory will be loaded. This directive may be specified
1625 multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple
1626 files or directories. The certificates will be presented to
1627 clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field
1628 matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
1629 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of
1630 the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
1631 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org). If no SNI is
1632 provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
1633 TLS extensions, or if the client provides and SNI which does
1634 not match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate
1635 will be presented. This means that when loading certificates
1636 from a directory, it is highly recommended to load the
1637 default one first as a file. Note that the same cert may be
1638 loaded multiple times without side effects.
1639
1640 <ciphers> is the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that
1641 is negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the
1642 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers", and can be for instance
1643 "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH".
1644
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001645 transparent is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain
1646 Linux kernels. It indicates that the addresses will be bound
1647 even if they do not belong to the local machine. Any packet
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001648 targeting any of these addresses will be caught just as if
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001649 the address was locally configured. This normally requires
1650 that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with
1651 the default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for
1652 the specified port. This keyword is available only when
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001653 HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1. This parameter is
1654 only compatible with TCP sockets.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001655
Willy Tarreau59f89202010-10-02 11:54:00 +02001656 defer-accept is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain
Willy Tarreaucb6cd432009-10-13 07:34:14 +02001657 Linux kernels. It states that a connection will only be
1658 accepted once some data arrive on it, or at worst after the
1659 first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols for
1660 which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly
1661 improve performance by ensuring that most of the request is
1662 already available when the connection is accepted. On the
1663 other hand, it will not be able to detect connections which
1664 don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
1665 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is
1666 never accepted until the client talks. This can cause issues
1667 with front firewalls which would see an established
1668 connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV.
1669
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001670 accept-proxy is an optional keyword which enforces use of the PROXY
1671 protocol over any connection accepted by this listener. The
1672 PROXY protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of the
1673 incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used,
1674 with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules
1675 which will only see the real connection address. Logs will
1676 reflect the addresses indicated in the protocol, unless it is
1677 violated, in which case the real address will still be used.
1678 This keyword combined with support from external components
1679 can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
1680 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and
1681 not even always usable.
1682
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001683 ssl enables SSL deciphering on connections instanciated from this
1684 listener. A certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All
1685 contents in the buffers will be in clear text, so that ACLs
1686 and HTTP processing will only have access to deciphered
1687 contents.
1688
1689 nosslv3 disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is supported. Note that
1690 SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled using any
1691 configuration option.
1692
1693 notlsv1 disables support for TLSv1 when SSL is supported. Note that
1694 SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled using any
1695 configuration option.
1696
1697 prefer-server-ciphers
1698 tells the SSL/TLS layer that our set of cipher algorithms is
1699 preferred over the client's ones.
1700
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001701 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1702 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1703 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1704 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1705 in a frontend.
1706
1707 Example :
1708 listen http_proxy
1709 bind :80,:443
1710 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001711 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001712
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001713 listen http_https_proxy
1714 bind :80
1715 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem prefer-server-ciphers
1716
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001717 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001718 documentation.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001719
1720
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001721bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32> ] ...
1722 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1723 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1724 yes | yes | yes | yes
1725 Arguments :
1726 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1727 may be used to override a default value.
1728
1729 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1730 option may be combined with other numbers.
1731
1732 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1733 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1734 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1735 missing from all processes.
1736
1737 number The instance will be enabled on this process number, between
1738 1 and 32. You must be careful not to reference a process
1739 number greater than the configured global.nbproc, otherwise
1740 some instances might be missing from all processes.
1741
1742 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1743 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1744 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1745 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1746 and 'even' instances.
1747
1748 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1749 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1750 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1751 32.
1752
1753 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1754 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1755
1756 Example :
1757 listen app_ip1
1758 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001759 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001760
1761 listen app_ip2
1762 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001763 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001764
1765 listen management
1766 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001767 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001768
1769 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1770
1771
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001772block { if | unless } <condition>
1773 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1774 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1775 no | yes | yes | yes
1776
1777 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1778 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001779 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001780 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001781 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1782 "block" statements per instance.
1783
1784 Example:
1785 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1786 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1787 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1788 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1789
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001790 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001791
1792
1793capture cookie <name> len <length>
1794 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1795 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1796 no | yes | yes | no
1797 Arguments :
1798 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1799 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1800 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1801 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1802 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1803
1804 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1805 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1806 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1807 right if it exceeds <length>.
1808
1809 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1810 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1811 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1812 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1813
1814 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1815 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1816 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1817
1818 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1819 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1820 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
1821 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001822 configured in the sources by default to 64 characters. It is not possible to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001823 specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1824
1825 Example:
1826 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1827
1828 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001829 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001830
1831
1832capture request header <name> len <length>
1833 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified request header.
1834 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1835 no | yes | yes | no
1836 Arguments :
1837 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001838 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001839 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1840 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1841 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1842
1843 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1844 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1845 it exceeds <length>.
1846
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001847 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001848 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1849 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001850 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1851 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1852 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1853 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001854 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001855 environments to find where the request came from.
1856
1857 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1858 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1859 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1860 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001861
1862 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers, but each capture
1863 is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent for a
1864 same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It is not
1865 possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1866
1867 Example:
1868 capture request header Host len 15
1869 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1870 capture request header Referrer len 15
1871
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001872 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001873 about logging.
1874
1875
1876capture response header <name> len <length>
1877 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified response header.
1878 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1879 no | yes | yes | no
1880 Arguments :
1881 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001882 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001883 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1884 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1885 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1886
1887 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1888 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1889 it exceeds <length>.
1890
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001891 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001892 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1893 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1894 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001895 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1896 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1897 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1898 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001899
1900 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers, but each
1901 capture is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent
1902 for a same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It
1903 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1904
1905 Example:
1906 capture response header Content-length len 9
1907 capture response header Location len 15
1908
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001909 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001910 about logging.
1911
1912
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001913clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001914 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1915 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1916 yes | yes | yes | no
1917 Arguments :
1918 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1919 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1920 as explained at the top of this document.
1921
1922 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1923 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1924 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1925 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1926 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1927 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1928 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1929 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001930 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001931 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1932 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1933
1934 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1935 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1936 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1937 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1938 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1939 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1940
1941 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1942 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1943
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001944 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1945 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001946
1947
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001948contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001949 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
1950 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1951 yes | no | yes | yes
1952 Arguments :
1953 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1954 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1955 as explained at the top of this document.
1956
1957 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001958 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001959 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001960 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
1961 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
1962 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
1963 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
1964
1965 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
1966 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1967 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1968 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1969 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
1970 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1971
1972 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
1973 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
1974 instead.
1975
1976 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
1977 "timeout server", "contimeout".
1978
1979
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02001980cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02001981 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
1982 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001983 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
1984 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1985 yes | no | yes | yes
1986 Arguments :
1987 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
1988 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
1989 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
1990 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
1991 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
1992 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
1993 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
1994 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
1995 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
1996
1997 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
1998 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
1999 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2000 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2001 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2002 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2003 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2004 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2005 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2006 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2007 "insert" and "prefix".
2008
2009 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002010 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002011
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002012 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002013 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2014 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2015 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2016 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2017 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2018 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2019 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2020 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2021 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2022 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002023
2024 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2025 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2026 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2027 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2028 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2029 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2030 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2031 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2032 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2033 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002034 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2035 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2036 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002037
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002038 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2039 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2040 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002041 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2042 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2043 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2044 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002045 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2046 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2047 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002048
2049 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2050 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2051 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2052 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2053 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2054 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2055 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2056 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2057 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2058
2059 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2060 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2061 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2062 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2063 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2064 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2065 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2066 persistence cookie in the cache.
2067 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2068
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002069 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2070 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2071 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2072 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2073 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2074 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2075 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2076 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2077 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2078 they logout.
2079
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002080 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2081 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2082 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2083 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2084
2085 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2086 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2087 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2088 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2089 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2090 this attribute.
2091
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002092 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002093 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002094 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2095 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2096 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2097 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2098 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2099 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002100
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002101 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2102 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2103 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2104 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2105 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2106 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2107 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2108 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2109 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2110 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2111 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2112 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2113 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2114 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2115 the site.
2116
2117 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2118 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2119 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2120 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2121 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2122 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2123 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2124 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2125 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2126 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2127 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2128 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2129 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2130 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2131 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2132 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2133
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002134 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2135 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2136 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2137 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002138
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002139 Examples :
2140 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2141 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2142 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002143 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002144
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002145 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002146 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002147
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002148
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002149default-server [param*]
2150 Change default options for a server in a backend
2151 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2152 yes | no | yes | yes
2153 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002154 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2155 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2156 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2157 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002158
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002159 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002160 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2161
2162 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002163
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002164
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002165default_backend <backend>
2166 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2167 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2168 yes | yes | yes | no
2169 Arguments :
2170 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2171
2172 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2173 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2174 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2175 will catch all undetermined requests.
2176
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002177 Example :
2178
2179 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2180 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2181 default_backend dynamic
2182
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002183 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2184
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002185
2186disabled
2187 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2188 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2189 yes | yes | yes | yes
2190 Arguments : none
2191
2192 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2193 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2194 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2195 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2196 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2197 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2198 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2199
2200 See also : "enabled"
2201
2202
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002203dispatch <address>:<port>
2204 Set a default server address
2205 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2206 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002207 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002208
2209 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2210 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2211 during start-up.
2212
2213 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2214 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2215 possible with normal servers.
2216
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002217 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002218 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2219 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2220 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2221 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2222
2223 See also : "server"
2224
2225
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002226enabled
2227 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2228 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2229 yes | yes | yes | yes
2230 Arguments : none
2231
2232 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2233 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2234
2235 See also : "disabled"
2236
2237
2238errorfile <code> <file>
2239 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2240 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2241 yes | yes | yes | yes
2242 Arguments :
2243 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002244 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002245
2246 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002247 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002248 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002249 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2250 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002251
2252 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2253 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2254 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2255
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002256 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2257
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002258 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2259 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2260 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2261 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2262
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002263 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2264 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2265 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2266 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2267 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2268 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2269
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002270 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2271 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2272 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002273 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002274 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2275
2276 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2277
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002278 Example :
2279 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2280 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2281 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2282
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002283
2284errorloc <code> <url>
2285errorloc302 <code> <url>
2286 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2287 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2288 yes | yes | yes | yes
2289 Arguments :
2290 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002291 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002292
2293 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2294 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2295 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2296 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2297 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2298
2299 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2300 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2301 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2302
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002303 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2304
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002305 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2306 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2307 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2308 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2309 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2310 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2311 request.
2312
2313 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2314
2315
2316errorloc303 <code> <url>
2317 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2318 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2319 yes | yes | yes | yes
2320 Arguments :
2321 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2322 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2323
2324 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2325 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2326 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2327 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2328 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2329
2330 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2331 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2332 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2333
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002334 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2335
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002336 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2337 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2338 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2339 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002340 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002341
2342 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2343
2344
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002345force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2346 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2347 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2348 no | yes | yes | yes
2349
2350 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2351 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2352 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2353 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2354 marked down for maintenance operations.
2355
2356 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2357 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2358 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2359 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2360 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2361 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2362 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2363 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2364 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2365
2366 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2367 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2368 is used.
2369
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002370 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002371 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002372
2373
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002374fullconn <conns>
2375 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2376 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2377 yes | no | yes | yes
2378 Arguments :
2379 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2380 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2381
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002382 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002383 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002384 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002385 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2386 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2387 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2388 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2389 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002390 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002391
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002392 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2393 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
2394 backend. That way it's safe to leave it unset.
2395
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002396 Example :
2397 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2398 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2399 # connections.
2400 backend dynamic
2401 fullconn 10000
2402 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2403 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2404
2405 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2406
2407
2408grace <time>
2409 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2410 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002411 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002412 Arguments :
2413 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2414 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2415 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2416
2417 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2418 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002419 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002420 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2421
2422 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2423 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2424 simplify it.
2425
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002426
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002427hash-type <method>
2428 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2429 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2430 yes | no | yes | yes
2431 Arguments :
2432 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2433 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but will
2434 be static in that weight changes while a server is up will be
2435 ignored. This means that there will be no slow start. Also,
2436 since a server is selected by its position in the array, most
2437 mappings are changed when the server count changes. This means
2438 that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is added
2439 to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to different
2440 servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for instance.
2441
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002442 avalanche this mechanism uses the default map-based hashing described
2443 above but applies a full avalanche hash before performing the
2444 mapping. The result is a slightly less smooth hash for most
2445 situations, but the hash becomes better than pure map-based
2446 hashes when the number of servers is a multiple of the size of
2447 the input set. When using URI hash with a number of servers
2448 multiple of 64, it's desirable to change the hash type to
2449 this value.
2450
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002451 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2452 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2453 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2454 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2455 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2456 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a server
2457 is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings are
2458 redistributed, making it an ideal algorithm for caches.
2459 However, due to its principle, the algorithm will never be very
2460 smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a server's
2461 weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution. In order
2462 to get the same distribution on multiple load balancers, it is
2463 important that all servers have the same IDs.
2464
2465 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages.
2466
2467 See also : "balance", "server"
2468
2469
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002470http-check disable-on-404
2471 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2472 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002473 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002474 Arguments : none
2475
2476 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2477 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2478 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2479 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2480 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2481 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2482 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2483 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002484 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2485 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2486 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2487
2488 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2489
2490
2491http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002492 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002493 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002494 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002495 Arguments :
2496 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2497 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002498 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002499 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2500 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2501 details on the supported keywords.
2502
2503 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2504 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2505 with the usual backslash ('\').
2506
2507 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2508 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2509 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2510 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2511 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2512
2513 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002514 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002515 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2516 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2517 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2518
2519 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002520 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002521 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2522 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2523 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2524 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2525
2526 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002527 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002528 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2529 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2530 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2531 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2532 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2533 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2534 trace).
2535
2536 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002537 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002538 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2539 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2540 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2541 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2542 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2543 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2544
2545 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2546 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2547 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2548 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2549 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2550 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2551 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2552 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2553
2554 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2555 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2556
2557 Examples :
2558 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002559 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002560
2561 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002562 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002563
2564 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002565 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002566
2567 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002568 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002569
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002570 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002571
2572
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002573http-check send-state
2574 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2575 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2576 yes | no | yes | yes
2577 Arguments : none
2578
2579 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2580 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2581 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2582 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2583 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2584
2585 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2586 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2587 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2588 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2589 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2590 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2591 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2592 checked in multiple backends.
2593
2594 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2595 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2596
2597 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2598 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2599 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2600 one fails.
2601
2602 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2603 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2604 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2605
2606 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2607 server's queue.
2608
2609 Example of a header received by the application server :
2610 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2611 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2612
2613 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2614
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002615http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002616 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002617 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2618
2619 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2620 no | yes | yes | yes
2621
2622 These set of options allow to fine control access to a
2623 frontend/listen/backend. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
2624 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002625 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
2626 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002627 should be asked to enter a username and password.
2628
2629 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
2630 instance.
2631
2632 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002633 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2634 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2635 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002636
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002637 http-request allow if nagios
2638 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2639 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2640 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002641
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002642 Example:
2643 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002644
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002645 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002646
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002647 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2648 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002649
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05002650http-send-name-header [<header>]
2651 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
2652
2653 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2654 yes | no | yes | yes
2655
2656 Arguments :
2657
2658 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
2659
2660 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
2661 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
2662 is added with the header string proved.
2663
2664 See also : "server"
2665
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002666id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02002667 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
2668 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2669 no | yes | yes | yes
2670 Arguments : none
2671
2672 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
2673 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
2674 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002675
2676
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002677ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2678 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
2679 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2680 no | yes | yes | yes
2681
2682 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
2683 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
2684 and running).
2685
2686 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2687 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
2688 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
2689 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
2690 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
2691
2692 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
2693 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
2694
2695 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2696 "unless" condition is met.
2697
2698 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
2699
2700
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002701log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002702log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002703no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002704 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
2705 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2706 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002707
2708 Prefix :
2709 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
2710 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
2711 prefix does not allow arguments.
2712
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002713 Arguments :
2714 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
2715 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
2716 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
2717 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
2718 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
2719 parameter.
2720
2721 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
2722 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
2723
2724 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
2725 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2726 standard syslog port).
2727
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01002728 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
2729 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2730 standard syslog port).
2731
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002732 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
2733 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
2734 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
2735 appropriately writeable).
2736
2737 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
2738
2739 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
2740 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
2741 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
2742
2743 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
2744 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
2745 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002746 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
2747 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
2748 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
2749 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
2750 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002751
2752 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2753
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002754 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
2755 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
2756 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002757
2758 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
2759 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
2760 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
2761 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
2762
2763 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
2764 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002765
2766 Example :
2767 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002768 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
2769 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002770
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01002771log-format <string>
2772 Allows you to custom a log line.
2773
2774 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
2775
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002776
2777maxconn <conns>
2778 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
2779 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2780 yes | yes | yes | no
2781 Arguments :
2782 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
2783 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
2784 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
2785 closes.
2786
2787 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
2788 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
2789 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
2790 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
2791 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
2792 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
2793 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
2794 properly tuned.
2795
2796 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
2797 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
2798 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
2799
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02002800 By default, this value is set to 2000.
2801
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002802 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
2803
2804
2805mode { tcp|http|health }
2806 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
2807 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2808 yes | yes | yes | yes
2809 Arguments :
2810 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
2811 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
2812 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
2813 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
2814
2815 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
2816 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
2817 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
2818 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
2819 brings HAProxy most of its value.
2820
2821 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
2822 to incoming connections and close the connection. Nothing will be
2823 logged. This mode is used to reply to external components health
2824 checks. This mode is deprecated and should not be used anymore as
2825 it is possible to do the same and even better by combining TCP or
2826 HTTP modes with the "monitor" keyword.
2827
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002828 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
2829 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
2830 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002831
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002832 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002833 defaults http_instances
2834 mode http
2835
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002836 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002837
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002838
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002839monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002840 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002841 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2842 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002843 Arguments :
2844 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
2845 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002846 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002847 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
2848 backend and its backup.
2849
2850 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
2851 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
2852 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
2853 servers in a list of backends.
2854
2855 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
2856 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
2857 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
2858 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
2859 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
2860 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
2861 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002862 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
2863 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002864
2865 Example:
2866 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002867 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002868 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
2869 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
2870 monitor-uri /site_alive
2871 monitor fail if site_dead
2872
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002873 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002874
2875
2876monitor-net <source>
2877 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
2878 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2879 yes | yes | yes | no
2880 Arguments :
2881 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
2882 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
2883 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
2884 followed by a mask.
2885
2886 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
2887 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002888 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002889 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
2890
2891 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
2892 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
2893 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
2894 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
2895 running without forwarding the request to a backend server.
2896
2897 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2898 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2899 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2900 nothing more. Right now, it is not possible to set failure conditions on
2901 requests caught by "monitor-net".
2902
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01002903 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
2904 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002905
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002906 Example :
2907 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
2908 frontend www
2909 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
2910
2911 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
2912
2913
2914monitor-uri <uri>
2915 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
2916 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2917 yes | yes | yes | no
2918 Arguments :
2919 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
2920 health status instead of forwarding the request.
2921
2922 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
2923 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
2924 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
2925 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
2926 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
2927 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
2928 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
2929 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
2930
2931 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2932 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2933 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2934 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
2935 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
2936 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
2937
2938 Example :
2939 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
2940 frontend www
2941 mode http
2942 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
2943
2944 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
2945
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002946
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002947option abortonclose
2948no option abortonclose
2949 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
2950 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2951 yes | no | yes | yes
2952 Arguments : none
2953
2954 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
2955 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
2956 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
2957 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002958 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002959 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
2960 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
2961 encountered while delivering the response.
2962
2963 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
2964 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
2965 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
2966 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
2967 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
2968 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002969 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002970 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002971 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002972 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
2973 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
2974 still not served and not pollute the servers.
2975
2976 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
2977 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
2978 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
2979 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
2980 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
2981 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
2982 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
2983 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002984 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002985
2986 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2987 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2988
2989 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
2990
2991
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002992option accept-invalid-http-request
2993no option accept-invalid-http-request
2994 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
2995 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2996 yes | yes | yes | no
2997 Arguments : none
2998
2999 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3000 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3001 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3002 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3003 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3004 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3005 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3006 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003007 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
3008 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
3009 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
3010 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
3011 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
3012 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003013
3014 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3015 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3016 been confirmed.
3017
3018 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3019 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003020 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
3021 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003022 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3023
3024 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3025 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3026
3027 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
3028 stats socket.
3029
3030
3031option accept-invalid-http-response
3032no option accept-invalid-http-response
3033 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
3034 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3035 yes | no | yes | yes
3036 Arguments : none
3037
3038 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3039 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3040 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3041 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3042 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3043 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3044 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3045 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
3046 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
3047
3048 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3049 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3050 been confirmed.
3051
3052 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3053 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3054 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3055 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3056
3057 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3058 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3059
3060 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3061 stats socket.
3062
3063
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003064option allbackups
3065no option allbackups
3066 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3067 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3068 yes | no | yes | yes
3069 Arguments : none
3070
3071 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3072 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3073 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3074 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3075 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3076 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3077 order between the backup servers anymore.
3078
3079 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3080 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3081
3082 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3083 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3084
3085
3086option checkcache
3087no option checkcache
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003088 Analyze all server responses and block requests with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003089 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3090 yes | no | yes | yes
3091 Arguments : none
3092
3093 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3094 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003095 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003096 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3097 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003098 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003099
3100 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003101 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003102 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003103 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3104 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003105 to the client are :
3106 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003107 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003108 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003109 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3110 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3111 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3112 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3113 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3114 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3115 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3116 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3117 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3118 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3119 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3120
3121 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003122 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003123 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003124 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003125 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3126
3127 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3128 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003129 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003130 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3131
3132 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3133 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3134
3135
3136option clitcpka
3137no option clitcpka
3138 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3139 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3140 yes | yes | yes | no
3141 Arguments : none
3142
3143 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3144 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3145 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3146 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3147
3148 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3149 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3150 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3151 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3152
3153 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3154 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3155 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3156 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3157 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3158
3159 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3160
3161 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3162 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3163 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3164
3165 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3166 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3167
3168 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3169
3170
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003171option contstats
3172 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3173 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3174 yes | yes | yes | no
3175 Arguments : none
3176
3177 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3178 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3179 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3180 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3181 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3182 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3183 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3184
3185
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003186option dontlog-normal
3187no option dontlog-normal
3188 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3189 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3190 yes | yes | yes | no
3191 Arguments : none
3192
3193 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3194 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3195 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3196 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3197 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3198 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3199 logged.
3200
3201 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3202 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3203 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3204
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003205 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003206 logging.
3207
3208
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003209option dontlognull
3210no option dontlognull
3211 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3212 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3213 yes | yes | yes | no
3214 Arguments : none
3215
3216 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3217 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3218 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3219 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3220 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3221 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3222 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3223
3224 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3225 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3226 would not be logged.
3227
3228 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3229 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3230
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003231 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003232
3233
3234option forceclose
3235no option forceclose
3236 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3237 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003238 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003239 Arguments : none
3240
3241 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3242 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3243 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3244 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3245 global session times in the logs.
3246
3247 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003248 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003249 to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that
3250 this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which
3251 means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some
3252 resources earlier than with httpclose.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003253
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003254 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3255 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3256 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3257
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003258 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3259 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3260
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003261 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003262
3263
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003264option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003265 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3266 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3267 yes | yes | yes | yes
3268 Arguments :
3269 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3270 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003271 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003272 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003273
3274 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3275 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3276 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3277 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3278 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3279 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3280 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003281 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3282 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3283 possible that the client has already brought one.
3284
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003285 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003286 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003287 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3288 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003289 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3290 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003291
3292 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3293 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3294 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3295 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3296 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3297 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3298 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3299
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003300 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3301 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3302 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3303 are under the control of the end-user.
3304
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003305 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003306 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3307 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003308 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3309 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3310 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003311
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003312 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3313 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3314 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3315 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3316 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003317
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003318 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003319 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3320 frontend www
3321 mode http
3322 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3323
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003324 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3325 backend www
3326 mode http
3327 option forwardfor header X-Client
3328
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003329 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3330 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003331
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003332
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003333option http-no-delay
3334no option http-no-delay
3335 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3336 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3337 yes | yes | yes | yes
3338 Arguments : none
3339
3340 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3341 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3342 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3343 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3344 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3345 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3346 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3347 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
3348 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
3349 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
3350 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
3351 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
3352 affected.
3353
3354 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
3355 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
3356 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
3357 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
3358 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
3359 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
3360 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
3361 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
3362 latency environments.
3363
3364
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003365option http-pretend-keepalive
3366no option http-pretend-keepalive
3367 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
3368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3369 yes | yes | yes | yes
3370 Arguments : none
3371
3372 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
3373 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
3374 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
3375 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
3376 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
3377 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
3378 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
3379 consider the response complete.
3380
3381 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
3382 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
3383 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
3384 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
3385 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
3386 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
3387
3388 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
3389 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
3390 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
3391 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
3392 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
3393 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
3394 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
3395
3396 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3397 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003398 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02003399 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
3400 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003401
3402 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3403 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3404
3405 See also : "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close"
3406
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003407
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003408option http-server-close
3409no option http-server-close
3410 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
3411 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3412 yes | yes | yes | yes
3413 Arguments : none
3414
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003415 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3416 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3417 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
3418 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
3419 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3420 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
3421 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
3422 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
3423 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
3424 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
3425 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
3426 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003427
3428 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3429 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3430 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3431 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003432 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3433 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003434
3435 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3436 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003437 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option
3438 http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose"
3439 basically achieve the same result as "forceclose".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003440
3441 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3442 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3443
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003444 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3445 "option httpclose" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003446
3447
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003448option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003449no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003450 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
3451 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3452 yes | yes | yes | no
3453 Arguments : none
3454
3455 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
3456 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
3457 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
3458 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
3459 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
3460 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
3461 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
3462
3463 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
3464 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
3465 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
3466 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
3467 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
3468 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
3469 request along its whole life.
3470
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01003471 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
3472 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
3473 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
3474 front of an existing proxy.
3475
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003476 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
3477
3478 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
3479 http-server-close".
3480
3481
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003482option httpchk
3483option httpchk <uri>
3484option httpchk <method> <uri>
3485option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
3486 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
3487 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3488 yes | no | yes | yes
3489 Arguments :
3490 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
3491 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
3492 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
3493 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
3494 ones.
3495
3496 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
3497 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
3498 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
3499
3500 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
3501 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
3502 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
3503 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
3504 after "\r\n" following the version string.
3505
3506 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
3507 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
3508 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
3509 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
3510 the lack of any response.
3511
3512 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
3513
3514 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
3515 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
3516 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
3517
3518 Examples :
3519 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
3520 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
3521 backend https_relay
3522 mode tcp
3523 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
3524 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
3525
3526 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003527 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
3528 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003529
3530
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003531option httpclose
3532no option httpclose
3533 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
3534 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3535 yes | yes | yes | yes
3536 Arguments : none
3537
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003538 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3539 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
3540 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
3541 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
3542 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
3543 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
3544 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003545
3546 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003547 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003548 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
3549 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
3550 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
3551 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
3552 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003553
3554 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3555 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
3556 If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose".
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003557 If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it
3558 basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003559
3560 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3561 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3562
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003563 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
3564 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003565
3566
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003567option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003568 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
3569 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3570 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003571 Arguments :
3572 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
3573 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
3574 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
3575 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
3576 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003577
3578 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3579 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3580 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
3581 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
3582 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
3583 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
3584 ports.
3585
3586 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3587
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003588 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3589 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
3590 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
3591 by default.
3592
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003593 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003594
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003595
3596option http_proxy
3597no option http_proxy
3598 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
3599 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3600 yes | yes | yes | yes
3601 Arguments : none
3602
3603 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
3604 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
3605 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
3606 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
3607 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
3608
3609 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
3610 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
3611 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
3612 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01003613 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003614 be analyzed.
3615
3616 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3617 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3618
3619 Example :
3620 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
3621 backend direct_forward
3622 option httpclose
3623 option http_proxy
3624
3625 See also : "option httpclose"
3626
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003627
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003628option independent-streams
3629no option independent-streams
3630 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003631 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3632 yes | yes | yes | yes
3633 Arguments : none
3634
3635 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
3636 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
3637 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
3638 receive data or not.
3639
3640 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
3641 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
3642 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
3643 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
3644 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
3645 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
3646 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
3647 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
3648 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
3649 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
3650 socket buffers.
3651
3652 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
3653 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
3654 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
3655 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
3656 slow lines, so use it with caution.
3657
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003658 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
3659 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
3660 deprecated.
3661
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003662 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003663
3664
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003665option ldap-check
3666 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
3667 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3668 yes | no | yes | yes
3669 Arguments : none
3670
3671 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
3672 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
3673 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
3674 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
3675
3676 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
3677 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
3678
3679 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
3680 configure it.
3681
3682 Example :
3683 option ldap-check
3684
3685 See also : "option httpchk"
3686
3687
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003688option log-health-checks
3689no option log-health-checks
3690 Enable or disable logging of health checks
3691 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3692 yes | no | yes | yes
3693 Arguments : none
3694
3695 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
3696 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
3697 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
3698 of additional information is limited.
3699
3700 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
3701 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
3702
3703 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
3704
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003705
3706option log-separate-errors
3707no option log-separate-errors
3708 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
3709 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3710 yes | yes | yes | no
3711 Arguments : none
3712
3713 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
3714 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
3715 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
3716 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
3717 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
3718 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
3719 provides very important information.
3720
3721 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
3722 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
3723 error logs.
3724
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003725 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003726 logging.
3727
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003728
3729option logasap
3730no option logasap
3731 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
3732 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3733 yes | yes | yes | no
3734 Arguments : none
3735
3736 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
3737 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
3738 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
3739 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
3740 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
3741 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
3742 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003743 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003744 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
3745 bytes are expected to be transferred.
3746
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003747 Examples :
3748 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
3749 mode http
3750 option httplog
3751 option logasap
3752 log 192.168.2.200 local3
3753
3754 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
3755 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
3756 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
3757 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
3758
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003759 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003760 logging.
3761
3762
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003763option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
3764 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003765 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3766 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003767 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003768 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
3769 server.
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003770
3771 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
3772 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
3773 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
3774 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
3775 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
3776 in the MySQL table, like this :
3777
3778 USE mysql;
3779 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
3780 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
3781
3782 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
3783 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
3784 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
3785 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
3786 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
3787 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
3788 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
3789 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
3790 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
3791
3792 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
3793 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003794
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02003795 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003796
3797 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
3798 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
3799 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3800 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3801 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
3802 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
3803
3804 See also: "option httpchk"
3805
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003806option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
3807 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
3808 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3809 yes | no | yes | yes
3810 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003811 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
3812 PostgreSQL server.
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003813
3814 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
3815 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
3816 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
3817 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
3818
3819 See also: "option httpchk"
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003820
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003821option nolinger
3822no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003823 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003824 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3825 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003826 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003827
3828 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
3829 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
3830 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
3831 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
3832 connections.
3833
3834 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
3835 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
3836 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
3837 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
3838 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
3839 this too.
3840
3841 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
3842 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
3843 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
3844
3845 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
3846 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
3847 for servers.
3848
3849 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3850 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3851
3852
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003853option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
3854 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
3855 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3856 yes | yes | yes | yes
3857 Arguments :
3858 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3859 matching <network>
3860 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
3861 header name.
3862
3863 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
3864 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
3865 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
3866 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
3867 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
3868 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
3869 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
3870 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
3871 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3872 possible that the client has already brought one.
3873
3874 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
3875 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
3876 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
3877 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
3878 header and requires different one.
3879
3880 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3881 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3882 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3883 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3884 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3885 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3886 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3887
3888 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
3889 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3890 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
3891 both are defined.
3892
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003893 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3894 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3895 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3896 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3897 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003898
3899 Examples :
3900 # Original Destination address
3901 frontend www
3902 mode http
3903 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
3904
3905 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
3906 backend www
3907 mode http
3908 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
3909
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003910 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3911 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003912
3913
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003914option persist
3915no option persist
3916 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
3917 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3918 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003919 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003920
3921 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
3922 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
3923 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
3924 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
3925 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
3926 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
3927 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
3928 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
3929 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
3930 redirected to another valid server.
3931
3932 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3933 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3934
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003935 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003936
3937
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003938option redispatch
3939no option redispatch
3940 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
3941 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3942 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003943 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003944
3945 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
3946 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
3947 be able to access the service anymore.
3948
3949 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
3950 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
3951
3952 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
3953 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
3954 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003955
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003956 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
3957 "redisp" keywords.
3958
3959 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3960 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3961
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003962 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003963
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003964
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003965option redis-check
3966 Use redis health checks for server testing
3967 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3968 yes | no | yes | yes
3969 Arguments : none
3970
3971 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
3972 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
3973 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
3974 find the "+PONG" response message.
3975
3976 Example :
3977 option redis-check
3978
3979 See also : "option httpchk"
3980
3981
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003982option smtpchk
3983option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
3984 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
3985 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3986 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003987 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003988 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
3989 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
3990 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
3991
3992 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
3993 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
3994 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
3995
3996 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
3997 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
3998 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
3999 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
4000 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
4001 dead server.
4002
4003 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
4004 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
4005 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
4006 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
4007
4008 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
4009 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
4010 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4011 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4012 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
4013
4014 Example :
4015 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
4016
4017 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
4018
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004019
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02004020option socket-stats
4021no option socket-stats
4022
4023 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
4024 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4025 yes | yes | yes | no
4026
4027 Arguments : none
4028
4029
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004030option splice-auto
4031no option splice-auto
4032 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
4033 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4034 yes | yes | yes | yes
4035 Arguments : none
4036
4037 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
4038 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
4039 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
4040 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004041 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004042 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
4043 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
4044 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
4045 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4046
4047 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
4048 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
4049 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
4050 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
4051 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
4052 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
4053 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
4054 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
4055 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
4056 keyword.
4057
4058 Example :
4059 option splice-auto
4060
4061 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4062 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4063
4064 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
4065 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4066
4067
4068option splice-request
4069no option splice-request
4070 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
4071 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4072 yes | yes | yes | yes
4073 Arguments : none
4074
4075 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004076 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004077 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4078 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4079 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4080 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4081
4082 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4083
4084 Example :
4085 option splice-request
4086
4087 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4088 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4089
4090 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
4091 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4092
4093
4094option splice-response
4095no option splice-response
4096 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
4097 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4098 yes | yes | yes | yes
4099 Arguments : none
4100
4101 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004102 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004103 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4104 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4105 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4106 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4107
4108 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4109
4110 Example :
4111 option splice-response
4112
4113 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4114 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4115
4116 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4117 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4118
4119
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004120option srvtcpka
4121no option srvtcpka
4122 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
4123 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4124 yes | no | yes | yes
4125 Arguments : none
4126
4127 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4128 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4129 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4130 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4131
4132 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4133 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4134 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4135 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4136
4137 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4138 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4139 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4140 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4141 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4142
4143 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4144
4145 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4146 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4147 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
4148
4149 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4150 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4151
4152 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
4153
4154
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004155option ssl-hello-chk
4156 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
4157 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4158 yes | no | yes | yes
4159 Arguments : none
4160
4161 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
4162 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
4163 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
4164 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
4165 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
4166 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
4167 hello message.
4168
4169 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
4170 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
4171 messages, which is appreciable.
4172
4173 See also: "option httpchk"
4174
4175
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004176option tcp-smart-accept
4177no option tcp-smart-accept
4178 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
4179 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4180 yes | yes | yes | no
4181 Arguments : none
4182
4183 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
4184 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
4185 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
4186 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
4187 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
4188 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
4189
4190 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
4191 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
4192 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
4193 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
4194
4195 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
4196 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
4197 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
4198 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
4199
4200 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
4201 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
4202 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
4203
4204 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
4205 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
4206 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
4207
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02004208 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
4209
4210
4211option tcp-smart-connect
4212no option tcp-smart-connect
4213 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
4214 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4215 yes | no | yes | yes
4216 Arguments : none
4217
4218 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
4219 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
4220 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
4221 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
4222 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
4223
4224 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
4225 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
4226 complex.
4227
4228 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
4229 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
4230 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
4231
4232 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4233 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4234
4235 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
4236
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004237
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004238option tcpka
4239 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
4240 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4241 yes | yes | yes | yes
4242 Arguments : none
4243
4244 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4245 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4246 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4247 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4248
4249 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4250 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4251 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4252 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4253
4254 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4255 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4256 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4257 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4258 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4259
4260 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4261
4262 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
4263 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
4264 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
4265 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
4266 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
4267 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
4268 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
4269 backends.
4270
4271 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
4272
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004273
4274option tcplog
4275 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
4276 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4277 yes | yes | yes | yes
4278 Arguments : none
4279
4280 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4281 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4282 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
4283 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
4284 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
4285 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
4286 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
4287 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
4288
4289 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4290
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004291 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004292
4293
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004294option transparent
4295no option transparent
4296 Enable client-side transparent proxying
4297 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01004298 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004299 Arguments : none
4300
4301 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
4302 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
4303 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
4304 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
4305 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
4306 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
4307 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
4308 appropriate server.
4309
4310 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
4311 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
4312
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01004313 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004314 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004315
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004316
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004317persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004318persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004319 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
4320 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4321 yes | no | yes | yes
4322 Arguments :
4323 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004324 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
4325 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004326
4327 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
4328 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
4329 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
4330 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
4331 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
4332 forwarded to this server.
4333
4334 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
4335 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
4336 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004337 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004338 a single "listen" section.
4339
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004340 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
4341 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
4342 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
4343
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004344 Example :
4345 listen tse-farm
4346 bind :3389
4347 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
4348 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
4349 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
4350 # apply RDP cookie persistence
4351 persist rdp-cookie
4352 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004353 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004354 balance rdp-cookie
4355 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
4356 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
4357
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09004358 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
4359 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004360
4361
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004362rate-limit sessions <rate>
4363 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
4364 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4365 yes | yes | yes | no
4366 Arguments :
4367 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
4368 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
4369
4370 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
4371 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
4372 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
4373 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
4374 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
4375 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
4376
4377 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
4378 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
4379 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
4380 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
4381
4382 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
4383 listen smtp
4384 mode tcp
4385 bind :25
4386 rate-limit sessions 10
4387 server 127.0.0.1:1025
4388
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02004389 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
4390 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
4391 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004392
4393 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
4394
4395
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004396redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4397redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4398redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004399 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
4400 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4401 no | yes | yes | yes
4402
4403 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004404 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004405
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004406 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004407 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
4408 the HTTP "Location" header.
4409
4410 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
4411 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
4412 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
4413 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
4414 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
4415 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie).
4416
4417 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
4418 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
4419 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
4420 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
4421 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
4422 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
4423 returned, which most recent browsers interprete as redirecting to
4424 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
4425 HTTPS.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004426
4427 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
4428 is desired. Only codes 301, 302 and 303 are supported, and 302 is
4429 used if no code is specified. 301 means "Moved permanently", and
4430 a browser may cache the Location. 302 means "Moved permanently"
4431 and means that the browser should not cache the redirection. 303
4432 is equivalent to 302 except that the browser will fetch the
4433 location with a GET method.
4434
4435 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
4436 expected behaviour of a redirection :
4437
4438 - "drop-query"
4439 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
4440 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
4441 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
4442 with a location-type redirect.
4443
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004444 - "append-slash"
4445 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
4446 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
4447 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
4448 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
4449
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004450 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
4451 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
4452 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
4453 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
4454 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
4455 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
4456 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
4457
4458 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
4459 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
4460 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
4461 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
4462 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
4463 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
4464 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004465
4466 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
4467 acl clear dst_port 80
4468 acl secure dst_port 8080
4469 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004470 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004471 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004472 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
4473
4474 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004475 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
4476 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
4477 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004478 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004479
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004480 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
4481 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
4482 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
4483
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004484 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
4485 redirect scheme https if !{ is_ssl }
4486
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004487 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004488
4489
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004490redisp (deprecated)
4491redispatch (deprecated)
4492 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4493 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4494 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004495 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004496
4497 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4498 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4499 be able to access the service anymore.
4500
4501 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
4502 redistribute them to a working server.
4503
4504 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4505 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4506 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004507
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004508 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
4509 "option redispatch" instead.
4510
4511 See also : "option redispatch"
4512
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004513
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004514reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004515 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
4516 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4517 no | yes | yes | yes
4518 Arguments :
4519 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4520 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004521 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004522
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004523 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4524 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4525
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004526 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4527 the last header of an HTTP request.
4528
4529 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4530 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4531 responses.
4532
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004533 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
4534 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
4535 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
4536
4537 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4538 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004539
4540
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004541reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4542reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004543 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4544 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4545 no | yes | yes | yes
4546 Arguments :
4547 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4548 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4549 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4550 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4551 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4552 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
4553 ignores case.
4554
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004555 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4556 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4557
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004558 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4559 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
4560 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4561 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004562 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004563
4564 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4565 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4566
4567 Example :
4568 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
4569 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4570 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4571
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004572 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
4573 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004574
4575
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004576reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4577reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004578 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
4579 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4580 no | yes | yes | yes
4581 Arguments :
4582 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4583 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4584 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4585 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4586 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
4587 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
4588
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004589 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4590 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4591
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004592 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
4593 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4594 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
4595 next servers.
4596
4597 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4598 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4599 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4600
4601 Example :
4602 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
4603 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
4604 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
4605
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004606 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4607 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004608
4609
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004610reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4611reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004612 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4613 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4614 no | yes | yes | yes
4615 Arguments :
4616 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4617 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4618 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4619 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4620 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4621 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
4622 case.
4623
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004624 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4625 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4626
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004627 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4628 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
4629 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4630 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004631 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004632
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004633 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004634 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004635 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004636
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004637 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4638 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4639
4640 Example :
4641 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
4642 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4643 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4644
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004645 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4646 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004647
4648
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004649reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4650reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004651 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
4652 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4653 no | yes | yes | yes
4654 Arguments :
4655 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4656 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4657 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4658 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4659 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4660 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
4661 case.
4662
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004663 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4664 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4665
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004666 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4667 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
4668 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
4669 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4670
4671 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4672 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4673
4674 Example :
4675 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
4676 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
4677 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4678 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4679
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004680 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4681 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004682
4683
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004684reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4685reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004686 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
4687 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4688 no | yes | yes | yes
4689 Arguments :
4690 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4691 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4692 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4693 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4694 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
4695 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
4696
4697 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4698 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4699 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4700 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004701 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004702
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004703 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4704 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4705
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004706 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
4707 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
4708 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
4709
4710 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4711 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4712 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4713 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
4714 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4715
4716 Example :
4717 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04004718 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004719 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
4720 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
4721
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004722 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", section 6 about HTTP header
4723 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004724
4725
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004726reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4727reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004728 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
4729 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4730 no | yes | yes | yes
4731 Arguments :
4732 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4733 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4734 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4735 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4736 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4737 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
4738 ignores case.
4739
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004740 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4741 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4742
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004743 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4744 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004745 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
4746 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
4747 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004748 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
4749 not set.
4750
4751 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
4752 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
4753 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
4754 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
4755 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
4756
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004757 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004758 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
4759 # block all others.
4760 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
4761 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
4762
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004763 # block bad guys
4764 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
4765 reqitarpit . if badguys
4766
4767 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
4768 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004769
4770
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02004771retries <value>
4772 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
4773 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4774 yes | no | yes | yes
4775 Arguments :
4776 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
4777 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
4778 default value is 3.
4779
4780 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
4781 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
4782 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
4783
4784 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
4785 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
4786
4787 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
4788 server even if a cookie references a different server.
4789
4790 See also : "option redispatch"
4791
4792
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004793rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004794 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
4795 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4796 no | yes | yes | yes
4797 Arguments :
4798 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4799 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004800 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004801
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004802 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4803 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4804
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004805 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4806 the last header of an HTTP response.
4807
4808 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4809 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4810 responses.
4811
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004812 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4813 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004814
4815
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004816rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4817rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004818 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
4819 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4820 no | yes | yes | yes
4821 Arguments :
4822 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4823 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4824 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4825 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4826 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4827 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
4828 ignores case.
4829
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004830 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4831 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4832
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004833 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
4834 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004835 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004836 client.
4837
4838 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4839 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4840 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4841
4842 Example :
4843 # remove the Server header from responses
4844 reqidel ^Server:.*
4845
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004846 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4847 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004848
4849
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004850rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4851rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004852 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
4853 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4854 no | yes | yes | yes
4855 Arguments :
4856 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4857 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4858 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4859 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4860 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4861 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
4862 ignores case.
4863
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004864 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4865 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4866
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004867 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4868 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
4869 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
4870 case-sensitive.
4871
4872 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004873 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
4874 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
4875 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004876
4877 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4878 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
4879
4880 Example :
4881 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
4882 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
4883
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004884 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
4885 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004886
4887
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004888rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4889rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004890 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
4891 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4892 no | yes | yes | yes
4893 Arguments :
4894 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4895 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4896 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4897 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4898 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4899 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
4900 ignores case.
4901
4902 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4903 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4904 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4905 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004906 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004907
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004908 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4909 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4910
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004911 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
4912 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
4913 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
4914
4915 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4916 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4917 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4918 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
4919 are not case-sensitive.
4920
4921 Example :
4922 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
4923 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
4924
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004925 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
4926 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004927
4928
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004929server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004930 Declare a server in a backend
4931 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4932 no | no | yes | yes
4933 Arguments :
4934 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004935 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-server-name" is
4936 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004937
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004938 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
4939 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4940 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
4941 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02004942 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
4943 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
4944 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
4945 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
4946 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
4947 to report statistics.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004948
4949 <ports> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
4950 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
4951 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
4952 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
4953 adding this value to the client's port.
4954
4955 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
4956 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004957 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004958
4959 Examples :
4960 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
4961 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
4962
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004963 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
4964 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004965
4966
4967source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004968source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004969source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004970 Set the source address for outgoing connections
4971 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4972 yes | no | yes | yes
4973 Arguments :
4974 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
4975 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
4976 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
4977 the most appropriate address to reach its destination.
4978
4979 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
4980 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02004981 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
4982 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
4983 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004984
4985 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
4986 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
4987 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
4988 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
4989 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
4990 <addr>.
4991
4992 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
4993 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
4994 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
4995 port.
4996
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004997 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
4998 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
4999 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
5000 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
5001 and to automatically bind to the the client's IP address as seen
5002 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
5003 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
5004 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
5005 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
5006 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
5007 HTTP header.
5008
5009 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
5010 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005011 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005012 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
5013 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
5014 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
5015 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
5016 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
5017 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
5018 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
5019
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005020 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
5021 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
5022 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
5023 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
5024 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
5025 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
5026
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005027 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
5028 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
5029 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
5030 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
5031
5032 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
5033 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
5034 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
5035 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
5036 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
5037 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
5038
5039 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
5040 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
5041 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
5042 there are two methods :
5043
5044 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
5045 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
5046 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
5047 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
5048 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
5049 of the client ranges may be used.
5050
5051 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
5052 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
5053 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
5054 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
5055 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
5056 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
5057 same session.
5058
5059 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
5060 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
5061 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
5062 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
5063 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
5064 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
5065
5066 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
5067 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
5068 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005069 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005070
5071 Examples :
5072 backend private
5073 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
5074 source 192.168.1.200
5075
5076 backend transparent_ssl1
5077 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
5078 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5079
5080 backend transparent_ssl2
5081 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
5082 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
5083 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
5084
5085 backend transparent_ssl3
5086 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
5087 # is more conntrack-friendly.
5088 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5089
5090 backend transparent_smtp
5091 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
5092 # with Tproxy version 4.
5093 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
5094
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005095 backend transparent_http
5096 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
5097 # proxy.
5098 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
5099
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005100 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005101 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
5102
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005103
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005104srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
5105 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
5106 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5107 yes | no | yes | yes
5108 Arguments :
5109 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5110 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5111 as explained at the top of this document.
5112
5113 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
5114 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
5115 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
5116 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
5117 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
5118 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
5119 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
5120
5121 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
5122 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
5123 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
5124 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
5125 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005126 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005127 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005128 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005129
5130 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5131 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5132 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5133 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5134 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5135 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5136
5137 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
5138 Please use "timeout server" instead.
5139
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005140 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
5141 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005142
5143
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005144stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
5145 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
5146 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5147 no | no | yes | yes
5148
5149 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
5150 matched.
5151
5152 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
5153 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
5154
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005155 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5156 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5157 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5158
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01005159 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
5160 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
5161 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
5162 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005163
5164 Example :
5165 # statistics admin level only for localhost
5166 backend stats_localhost
5167 stats enable
5168 stats admin if LOCALHOST
5169
5170 Example :
5171 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
5172 backend stats_auth
5173 stats enable
5174 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
5175 stats admin if TRUE
5176
5177 Example :
5178 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
5179 userlist stats-auth
5180 group admin users admin
5181 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
5182 group readonly users haproxy
5183 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
5184
5185 backend stats_auth
5186 stats enable
5187 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
5188 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
5189 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
5190 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
5191
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005192 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
5193 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5194 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005195
5196
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005197stats auth <user>:<passwd>
5198 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
5199 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5200 yes | no | yes | yes
5201 Arguments :
5202 <user> is a user name to grant access to
5203
5204 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
5205
5206 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
5207 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
5208 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
5209 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
5210 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
5211 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
5212
5213 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
5214 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
5215 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005216 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005217
5218 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
5219 report using "stats scope".
5220
5221 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5222 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5223 unobvious parameters.
5224
5225 Example :
5226 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5227 backend public_www
5228 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5229 stats enable
5230 stats hide-version
5231 stats scope .
5232 stats uri /admin?stats
5233 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5234 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5235 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5236
5237 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5238 backend private_monitoring
5239 stats enable
5240 stats uri /admin?stats
5241 stats refresh 5s
5242
5243 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
5244
5245
5246stats enable
5247 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
5248 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5249 yes | no | yes | yes
5250 Arguments : none
5251
5252 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
5253 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
5254 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
5255 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
5256 - stats auth : no authentication
5257 - stats scope : no restriction
5258
5259 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5260 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5261 unobvious parameters.
5262
5263 Example :
5264 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5265 backend public_www
5266 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5267 stats enable
5268 stats hide-version
5269 stats scope .
5270 stats uri /admin?stats
5271 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5272 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5273 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5274
5275 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5276 backend private_monitoring
5277 stats enable
5278 stats uri /admin?stats
5279 stats refresh 5s
5280
5281 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5282
5283
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005284stats hide-version
5285 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005286 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5287 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005288 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005289
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005290 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
5291 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
5292 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
5293 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
5294 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
5295 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005296
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005297 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5298 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5299 unobvious parameters.
5300
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005301 Example :
5302 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5303 backend public_www
5304 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005305 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005306 stats hide-version
5307 stats scope .
5308 stats uri /admin?stats
5309 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5310 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5311 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005312
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005313 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5314 backend private_monitoring
5315 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005316 stats uri /admin?stats
5317 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01005318
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005319 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005320
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005321
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02005322stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
5323 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5324 Access control for statistics
5325
5326 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5327 no | no | yes | yes
5328
5329 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
5330 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
5331 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
5332 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
5333 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
5334 should be asked to enter a username and password.
5335
5336 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
5337 instance.
5338
5339 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5340 about ACL usage.
5341
5342
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005343stats realm <realm>
5344 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
5345 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5346 yes | no | yes | yes
5347 Arguments :
5348 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
5349 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
5350 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
5351
5352 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
5353 using a backslash ('\').
5354
5355 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
5356 only related to authentication.
5357
5358 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5359 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5360 unobvious parameters.
5361
5362 Example :
5363 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5364 backend public_www
5365 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5366 stats enable
5367 stats hide-version
5368 stats scope .
5369 stats uri /admin?stats
5370 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5371 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5372 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5373
5374 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5375 backend private_monitoring
5376 stats enable
5377 stats uri /admin?stats
5378 stats refresh 5s
5379
5380 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
5381
5382
5383stats refresh <delay>
5384 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
5385 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5386 yes | no | yes | yes
5387 Arguments :
5388 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
5389 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
5390 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
5391 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
5392 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
5393 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
5394
5395 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
5396 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
5397 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
5398 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
5399
5400 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5401 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5402 unobvious parameters.
5403
5404 Example :
5405 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5406 backend public_www
5407 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5408 stats enable
5409 stats hide-version
5410 stats scope .
5411 stats uri /admin?stats
5412 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5413 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5414 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5415
5416 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5417 backend private_monitoring
5418 stats enable
5419 stats uri /admin?stats
5420 stats refresh 5s
5421
5422 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5423
5424
5425stats scope { <name> | "." }
5426 Enable statistics and limit access scope
5427 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5428 yes | no | yes | yes
5429 Arguments :
5430 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
5431 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
5432 section in which the statement appears.
5433
5434 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
5435 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
5436 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
5437 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
5438 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
5439 exists.
5440
5441 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5442 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5443 unobvious parameters.
5444
5445 Example :
5446 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5447 backend public_www
5448 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5449 stats enable
5450 stats hide-version
5451 stats scope .
5452 stats uri /admin?stats
5453 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5454 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5455 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5456
5457 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5458 backend private_monitoring
5459 stats enable
5460 stats uri /admin?stats
5461 stats refresh 5s
5462
5463 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5464
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005465
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005466stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005467 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
5468 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5469 yes | no | yes | yes
5470
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005471 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005472 description from global section is automatically used instead.
5473
5474 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5475 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
5476
5477 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5478 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005479 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005480
5481 Example :
5482 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5483 backend private_monitoring
5484 stats enable
5485 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
5486 stats uri /admin?stats
5487 stats refresh 5s
5488
5489 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
5490 global section.
5491
5492
5493stats show-legends
5494 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
5495 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
5496 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
5497 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
5498 - IP (socket, server)
5499 - cookie (backend, server)
5500
5501 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5502 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005503 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005504
5505 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
5506
5507
5508stats show-node [ <name> ]
5509 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
5510 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5511 yes | no | yes | yes
5512 Arguments:
5513 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
5514 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
5515
5516 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5517 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005518 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005519
5520 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5521 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5522 unobvious parameters.
5523
5524 Example:
5525 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5526 backend private_monitoring
5527 stats enable
5528 stats show-node Europe-1
5529 stats uri /admin?stats
5530 stats refresh 5s
5531
5532 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
5533 section.
5534
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005535
5536stats uri <prefix>
5537 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
5538 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5539 yes | no | yes | yes
5540 Arguments :
5541 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
5542 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
5543 query string.
5544
5545 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
5546 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
5547 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
5548 possible to reach it in the application.
5549
5550 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005551 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005552 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
5553 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
5554 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
5555 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
5556
5557 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
5558 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
5559 an address or a port to statistics only.
5560
5561 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5562 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5563 unobvious parameters.
5564
5565 Example :
5566 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5567 backend public_www
5568 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5569 stats enable
5570 stats hide-version
5571 stats scope .
5572 stats uri /admin?stats
5573 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5574 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5575 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5576
5577 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5578 backend private_monitoring
5579 stats enable
5580 stats uri /admin?stats
5581 stats refresh 5s
5582
5583 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
5584
5585
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005586stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
5587 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005588 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005589 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005590
5591 Arguments :
5592 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5593 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5594 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
5595 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
5596
5597 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5598 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5599 the "stick-table" statement.
5600
5601 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
5602 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
5603 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
5604 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
5605 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
5606
5607 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5608 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
5609 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
5610 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
5611 transformation rules.
5612
5613 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5614 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5615 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5616 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5617 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5618 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5619 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5620
5621 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
5622 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
5623 ACL based conditions.
5624
5625 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
5626 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
5627 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
5628 matches can be used as fallbacks.
5629
5630 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
5631 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
5632 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
5633 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
5634
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005635 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5636 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5637 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5638
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005639 Example :
5640 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5641 # last 30 minutes
5642 backend pop
5643 mode tcp
5644 balance roundrobin
5645 stick store-request src
5646 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5647 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5648 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5649
5650 backend smtp
5651 mode tcp
5652 balance roundrobin
5653 stick match src table pop
5654 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5655 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5656
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005657 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5658 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005659
5660
5661stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5662 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
5663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5664 no | no | yes | yes
5665
5666 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
5667 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
5668 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
5669 for writing more maintainable configurations.
5670
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005671 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5672 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5673 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5674
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005675 Examples :
5676 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01005677 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005678
5679 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
5680 stick match src table pop if !localhost
5681 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
5682
5683
5684 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
5685 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
5686 backend http
5687 mode http
5688 balance roundrobin
5689 stick on src table https
5690 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5691 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
5692 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
5693
5694 backend https
5695 mode tcp
5696 balance roundrobin
5697 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5698 stick on src
5699 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5700 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5701
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005702 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005703
5704
5705stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5706 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5707 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5708 no | no | yes | yes
5709
5710 Arguments :
5711 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5712 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5713 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5714 server is selected.
5715
5716 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5717 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5718 the "stick-table" statement.
5719
5720 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5721 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5722 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
5723 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
5724 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
5725 address.
5726
5727 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5728 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
5729 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
5730 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
5731 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
5732 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
5733 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
5734 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
5735 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
5736 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
5737
5738 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5739 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5740 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5741 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5742 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5743 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5744 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5745
5746 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
5747 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5748 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
5749 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5750
5751 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
5752 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5753 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5754 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5755 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5756 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5757 another protocol or access method.
5758
5759 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
5760 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
5761 the request.
5762
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005763 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5764 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5765 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5766
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005767 Example :
5768 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5769 # last 30 minutes
5770 backend pop
5771 mode tcp
5772 balance roundrobin
5773 stick store-request src
5774 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5775 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5776 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5777
5778 backend smtp
5779 mode tcp
5780 balance roundrobin
5781 stick match src table pop
5782 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5783 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5784
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005785 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5786 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005787
5788
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005789stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005790 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
5791 [store <data_type>]*
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005792 Configure the stickiness table for the current backend
5793 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005794 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005795
5796 Arguments :
5797 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
5798 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
5799 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5800 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5801
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01005802 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
5803 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
5804 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5805 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5806
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005807 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
5808 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
5809 instance.
5810
5811 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
5812 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
5813 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5814 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
5815 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
5816 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005817 to 32 characters.
5818
5819 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
5820 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
5821 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5822 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
5823 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
5824 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005825
5826 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005827 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
5828 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005829 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
5830 increase.
5831
5832 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005833 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
5834 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
5835 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005836
5837 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
5838 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
5839 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
5840 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
5841 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
5842 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
5843 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
5844 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
5845 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
5846 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
5847 parameter (see below).
5848
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005849 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
5850 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
5851 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
5852 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
5853 soft restart.
5854
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005855 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
5856
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005857 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
5858 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
5859 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
5860 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
5861 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005862 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005863 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
5864 if not expiration delay is specified.
5865
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005866 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
5867 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
5868 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
5869 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005870 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
5871 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
5872 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
5873 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
5874 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
5875 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
5876 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
5877 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
5878 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
5879 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
5880 types and their arguments.
5881
5882 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
5883 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
5884 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
5885 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
5886
5887 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
5888 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
5889 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
5890 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
5891
5892 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5893 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
5894 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
5895 they were received.
5896
5897 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5898 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
5899 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
5900 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
5901 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
5902
5903 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5904 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5905 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5906 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
5907 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5908
5909 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5910 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
5911 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
5912
5913 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5914 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5915 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5916 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
5917 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5918
5919 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5920 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
5921 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
5922 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
5923 the client side.
5924
5925 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5926 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5927 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5928 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
5929 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
5930 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
5931 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
5932
5933 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5934 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
5935 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
5936 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
5937 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
5938 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
5939 (eg: vulnerability scan).
5940
5941 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5942 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5943 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5944 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
5945 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
5946 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5947
5948 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5949 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
5950 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
5951 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
5952
5953 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5954 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5955 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5956 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5957 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5958 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
5959 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
5960 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
5961 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
5962 recommended for better fairness.
5963
5964 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5965 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
5966 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
5967 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
5968
5969 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
5970 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5971 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5972 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5973 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5974 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
5975 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
5976 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
5977 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
5978 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005979
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005980 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
5981 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005982 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
5983 reference it.
5984
5985 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
5986 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
5987 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
5988 as an exclusive stickiness.
5989
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005990 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
5991 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
5992 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
5993 something that can be ignored.
5994
5995 Example:
5996 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
5997 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
5998 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
5999 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
6000
6001 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01006002 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006003
6004
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006005stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6006 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6007 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6008 no | no | yes | yes
6009
6010 Arguments :
6011 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
6012 describes what elements of the response or connection will
6013 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6014 server is selected.
6015
6016 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6017 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6018 the "stick-table" statement.
6019
6020 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6021 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6022 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
6023 when the response is a SSL server hello.
6024
6025 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6026 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
6027 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
6028 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
6029 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
6030 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006031 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006032 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
6033 rules.
6034
6035 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6036 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6037 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6038 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6039 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6040 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6041 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6042
6043 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
6044 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6045 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
6046 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6047
6048 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
6049 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6050 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6051 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6052 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6053 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
6054 another protocol or access method.
6055
6056 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
6057
6058 Example :
6059 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
6060 backend https
6061 mode tcp
6062 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006063 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006064 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006065
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006066 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
6067 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
6068
6069 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
6070 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6071 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
6072
6073 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
6074 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006075
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006076 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
6077 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
6078 # at offset 44.
6079
6080 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
6081 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
6082
6083 # Learn on response if server hello.
6084 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006085
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006086 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6087 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6088
6089 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
6090 extraction.
6091
6092
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006093tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6094 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006095 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6096 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006097 Arguments :
6098 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6099 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
6100 See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006101
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006102 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006103
6104 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
6105 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006106 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
6107 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
6108 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
6109 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
6110 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
6111 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006112
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006113 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
6114 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
6115 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
6116 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006117
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006118 Three types of actions are supported :
6119 - accept :
6120 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6121 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6122 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006123
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006124 - reject :
6125 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6126 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6127 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
6128 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
6129 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
6130 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
6131 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
6132 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
6133 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
6134 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
6135 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
6136 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006137
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006138 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
6139 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
6140 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
6141 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
6142 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
6143 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
6144 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
6145 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
6146 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006147
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006148 These actions take one or two arguments :
6149 <key> is mandatory, and defines the criterion the tracking key will
6150 be derived from. At the moment, only "src" is supported. With
6151 it, the key will be the connection's source IPv4 address.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006152
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006153 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
6154 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
6155 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
6156 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006157
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006158 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
6159 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
6160 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
6161 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
6162 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
6163 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
6164 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
6165 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
6166 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
6167 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006168
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006169 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6170 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6171 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006172
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006173 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
6174 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
6175 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006176
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006177 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006178 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006179 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006180
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006181 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
6182 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
6183 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006184
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006185 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
6186 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6187 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006188
6189 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6190
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006191 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006192
6193
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006194tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6195 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006196 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006197 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006198 Arguments :
6199 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6200 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
6201 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006202
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006203 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006204
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006205 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
6206 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6207 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
6208 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
6209 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006210
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006211 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
6212 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
6213 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
6214 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
6215 both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new
6216 connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned
6217 a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated
6218 several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned
6219 (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006220
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006221 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6222 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6223 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6224 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006225
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006226 Three types of actions are supported :
6227 - accept :
6228 - reject :
6229 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006230
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006231 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
6232 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006233
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006234 Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule
6235 defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session
6236 releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case
6237 of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. While there is nothing
6238 mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the track-sc1 pointer to track
6239 per-frontend counters and track-sc2 to track per-backend counters.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006240
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006241 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006242 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6243 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006244
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006245 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006246 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
6247 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
6248 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
6249 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
6250 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006251
6252 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006253 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
6254 # and reject everything else.
6255 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
6256 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006257 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006258 tcp-request content reject
6259
6260 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006261 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
6262 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6263 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006264 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006265
6266 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
6267 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6268 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006269 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006270 tcp-request content reject
6271
6272 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
6273 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
6274
6275 frontend http
6276 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC1 as a global abuse counter
6277 # protecting all our sites
6278 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
6279 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6280 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
6281 ...
6282 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
6283
6284 backend http_dynamic
6285 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
6286 # by SC2), block it globally in the frontend.
6287 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
6288 acl click_too_fast sc2_http_req_rate gt 10
6289 acl mark_as_abuser sc1_inc_gpc0
6290 tcp-request content track-sc2 src
6291 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006292
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006293 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006294
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006295 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006296
6297
6298tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
6299 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
6300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006301 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006302 Arguments :
6303 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6304 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6305 as explained at the top of this document.
6306
6307 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
6308 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
6309 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
6310 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
6311 data for at most the specified amount of time.
6312
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006313 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
6314 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
6315 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
6316 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
6317
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006318 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
6319 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006320 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006321 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01006322 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
6323 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
6324 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
6325 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006326
6327 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
6328 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
6329 it pass through unaffected.
6330
6331 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
6332 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
6333 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006334 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006335 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
6336 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02006337 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
6338 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
6339 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006340
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006341 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006342 "timeout client".
6343
6344
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006345tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6346 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
6347 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6348 no | no | yes | yes
6349 Arguments :
6350 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6351 actions include : "accept", "reject".
6352 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
6353
6354 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
6355
6356 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
6357 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6358 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
6359 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection delay is
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006360 set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006361
6362 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
6363
6364 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6365 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6366 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6367 inserted.
6368
6369 Two types of actions are supported :
6370 - accept :
6371 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6372 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6373 the rules evaluation.
6374
6375 - reject :
6376 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6377 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006378 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006379
6380 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6381 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6382 for changing the default action to a reject.
6383
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006384 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
6385 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
6386 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
6387 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006388 period.
6389
6390 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6391
6392 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
6393
6394
6395tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
6396 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
6397 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6398 no | no | yes | yes
6399 Arguments :
6400 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6401 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6402 as explained at the top of this document.
6403
6404 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
6405
6406
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006407timeout check <timeout>
6408 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
6409 established.
6410
6411 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6412 yes | no | yes | yes
6413 Arguments:
6414 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6415 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6416 as explained at the top of this document.
6417
6418 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
6419 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
6420 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
6421 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01006422 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
6423 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
6424 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006425
6426 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
6427 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
6428
6429 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
6430 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006431 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006432
6433 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6434 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6435 forget about it.
6436
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006437 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
6438 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006439
6440
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006441timeout client <timeout>
6442timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6443 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
6444 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6445 yes | yes | yes | no
6446 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006447 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006448 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6449 as explained at the top of this document.
6450
6451 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
6452 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6453 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
6454 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
6455 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
6456 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
6457 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
6458 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006459 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006460 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006461 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
6462 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
6463 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006464
6465 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
6466 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6467 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6468 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6469 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6470 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6471
6472 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
6473 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
6474 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6475
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006476 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006477
6478
6479timeout connect <timeout>
6480timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6481 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
6482 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6483 yes | no | yes | yes
6484 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006485 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006486 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6487 as explained at the top of this document.
6488
6489 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006490 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006491 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006492 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006493 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
6494 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006495
6496 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6497 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6498 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6499 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6500 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
6501 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6502
6503 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
6504 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
6505 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6506
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006507 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
6508 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006509
6510
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006511timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
6512 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
6513 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6514 yes | yes | yes | yes
6515 Arguments :
6516 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6517 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6518 as explained at the top of this document.
6519
6520 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
6521 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
6522 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
6523 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
6524 once the request has started to present itself.
6525
6526 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
6527 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
6528 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
6529 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
6530 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
6531
6532 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
6533 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
6534 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
6535 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
6536
6537 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
6538 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
6539 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
6540 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
6541 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02006542 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006543
6544 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
6545 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
6546 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
6547 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
6548
6549 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
6550
6551
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006552timeout http-request <timeout>
6553 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
6554 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006555 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006556 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006557 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006558 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6559 as explained at the top of this document.
6560
6561 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
6562 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
6563 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
6564 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
6565 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
6566 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
6567 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
6568 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
6569
6570 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
6571 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006572 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
6573 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006574
6575 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
6576 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
6577 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
6578 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
6579 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
6580
6581 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006582 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
6583 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
6584 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006585
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006586 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006587
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006588
6589timeout queue <timeout>
6590 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
6591 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6592 yes | no | yes | yes
6593 Arguments :
6594 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6595 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6596 as explained at the top of this document.
6597
6598 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
6599 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
6600 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
6601 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
6602 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
6603
6604 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
6605 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
6606 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
6607 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
6608
6609 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6610
6611
6612timeout server <timeout>
6613timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6614 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6615 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6616 yes | no | yes | yes
6617 Arguments :
6618 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6619 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6620 as explained at the top of this document.
6621
6622 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6623 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6624 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6625 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6626 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6627 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6628 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6629
6630 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6631 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6632 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6633 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6634 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006635 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006636 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006637 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
6638 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
6639 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
6640 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006641
6642 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6643 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6644 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6645 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6646 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6647 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6648
6649 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
6650 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
6651 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6652
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006653 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006654
6655
6656timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006657 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006658 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6659 yes | yes | yes | yes
6660 Arguments :
6661 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
6662 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6663 as explained at the top of this document.
6664
6665 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
6666 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
6667 defines how long it will be maintained open.
6668
6669 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6670 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6671 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
6672 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006673 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006674
6675 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6676
6677
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006678timeout tunnel <timeout>
6679 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
6680 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6681 yes | no | yes | yes
6682 Arguments :
6683 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6684 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6685 as explained at the top of this document.
6686
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006687 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006688 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
6689 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
6690 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
6691 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
6692 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
6693 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
6694 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
6695 specified.
6696
6697 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6698 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6699 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
6700 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
6701 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
6702
6703 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6704 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6705 forget about it.
6706
6707 Example :
6708 defaults http
6709 option http-server-close
6710 timeout connect 5s
6711 timeout client 30s
6712 timeout client 30s
6713 timeout server 30s
6714 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
6715
6716 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server".
6717
6718
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006719transparent (deprecated)
6720 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6721 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006722 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006723 Arguments : none
6724
6725 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
6726 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6727 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6728 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6729 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6730 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6731 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6732 appropriate server.
6733
6734 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
6735
6736 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6737 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6738
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006739 See also: "option transparent"
6740
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006741unique-id-format <string>
6742 Generate a unique ID for each request.
6743 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6744 yes | yes | yes | no
6745 Arguments :
6746 <string> is a log-format string.
6747
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006748 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
6749 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
6750 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
6751 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006752
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006753 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
6754 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
6755 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
6756 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
6757 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
6758 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
6759 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
6760 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006761
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006762 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
6763 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006764
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006765 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006766
6767 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
6768
6769 will generate:
6770
6771 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
6772
6773 See also: "unique-id-header"
6774
6775unique-id-header <name>
6776 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
6777 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6778 yes | yes | yes | no
6779 Arguments :
6780 <name> is the name of the header.
6781
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006782 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
6783 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006784
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006785 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006786
6787 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
6788 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
6789
6790 will generate:
6791
6792 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
6793
6794 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006795
6796use_backend <backend> if <condition>
6797use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006798 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006799 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6800 no | yes | yes | no
6801 Arguments :
6802 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
6803
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006804 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006805
6806 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
6807 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
6808 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006809 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
6810 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
6811 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
6812 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006813
6814 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
6815 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
6816 assign the backend.
6817
6818 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
6819 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6820 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
6821 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
6822 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
6823 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
6824
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006825 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006826 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006827 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
6828 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
6829 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
6830
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006831 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006832
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006833
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02006834use-server <server> if <condition>
6835use-server <server> unless <condition>
6836 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
6837 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6838 no | no | yes | yes
6839 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006840 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02006841
6842 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
6843
6844 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
6845 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
6846 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
6847
6848 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
6849 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
6850 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
6851 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
6852 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
6853 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
6854 matches will assign the server.
6855
6856 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
6857 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
6858 with the next rules until one matches.
6859
6860 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
6861 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6862 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
6863 according to other persistence mechanisms.
6864
6865 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
6866 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
6867 stripped.
6868
6869 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
6870 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
6871 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
6872 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
6873
6874 Example :
6875 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
6876 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
6877 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
6878 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
6879 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
6880 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
6881 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
6882 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
6883 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
6884
6885 See also: "use_backend", serction 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
6886
6887
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010068885. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006889------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006890
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006891The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
6892which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
6893arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
6894settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
6895after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
6896Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
6897address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006898
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006899 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006900 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006901
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006902The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006903
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02006904addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006905 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
6906 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
6907 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
6908 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
6909 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006910
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006911 Supported in default-server: No
6912
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006913backup
6914 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
6915 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
6916 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
6917 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
6918 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
6919 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006920
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006921 Supported in default-server: No
6922
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006923check
6924 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01006925 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
6926 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
6927 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
6928 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
6929 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
6930 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
6931 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
6932 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
6933 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
6934 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006935
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006936 Supported in default-server: No
6937
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02006938ciphers <ciphers>
6939 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
6940 is negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
6941 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
6942 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
6943 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
6944 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
6945 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
6946 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
6947
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006948cookie <value>
6949 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
6950 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
6951 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
6952 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
6953 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
6954 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
6955 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
6956
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006957 Supported in default-server: No
6958
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02006959disabled
6960 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
6961 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
6962 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
6963 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
6964 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
6965
6966 Supported in default-server: No
6967
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006968error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006969 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
6970 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
6971 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006972
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006973 Supported in default-server: Yes
6974
6975 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006976
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006977fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006978 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
6979 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
6980 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
6981
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006982 Supported in default-server: Yes
6983
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006984id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006985 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
6986 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
6987 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006988
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006989 Supported in default-server: No
6990
6991inter <delay>
6992fastinter <delay>
6993downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006994 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
6995 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
6996 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
6997 between checks depending on the server state :
6998
6999 Server state | Interval used
7000 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7001 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
7002 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7003 Transitionally UP (going down), |
7004 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
7005 or yet unchecked. |
7006 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7007 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
7008 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007009
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007010 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
7011 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
7012 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
7013 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
7014 hosted on the same hardware, the health-checks of all servers are started
7015 with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to add some random
7016 noise in the health checks interval using the global "spread-checks"
7017 keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot of backends use the same
7018 servers.
7019
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007020 Supported in default-server: Yes
7021
7022maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007023 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
7024 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
7025 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
7026 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
7027 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
7028 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
7029 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
7030 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
7031
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007032 Supported in default-server: Yes
7033
7034maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007035 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
7036 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
7037 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
7038 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
7039 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
7040 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
7041 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
7042
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007043 Supported in default-server: Yes
7044
7045minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007046 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
7047 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
7048 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
7049 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
7050 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
7051 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007052 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007053 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007054
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007055 Supported in default-server: Yes
7056
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007057nosslv3
7058 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
7059 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7060 using any configuration option.
7061
7062notlsv1
7063 This option disables support for TLSv1 when SSL is used to communicate with
7064 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7065 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
7066 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers.
7067
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09007068non-stick
7069 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
7070 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
7071 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
7072
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007073observe <mode>
7074 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
7075 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
7076 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
7077 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
7078 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
7079 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01007080 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007081
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007082 Supported in default-server: No
7083
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007084 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
7085
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007086on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007087 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
7088 Currently, four modes are available:
7089 - fastinter: force fastinter
7090 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
7091 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
7092 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
7093 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
7094
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007095 Supported in default-server: Yes
7096
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007097 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
7098
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09007099on-marked-down <action>
7100 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
7101 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07007102 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
7103 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
7104 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
7105 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
7106 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
7107 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
7108 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
7109 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09007110
7111 Actions are disabled by default
7112
7113 Supported in default-server: Yes
7114
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07007115on-marked-up <action>
7116 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
7117 Currently one action is available:
7118 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
7119 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
7120 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
7121 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
7122 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
7123 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
7124 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
7125 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
7126
7127 Actions are disabled by default
7128
7129 Supported in default-server: Yes
7130
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007131port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007132 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
7133 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
7134 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
7135 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
7136 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
7137 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
7138
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007139 Supported in default-server: Yes
7140
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007141redir <prefix>
7142 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
7143 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
7144 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
7145 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
7146 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
7147 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
7148 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
7149 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007150 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007151 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
7152 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
7153 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
7154 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
7155 loop between the client and HAProxy!
7156
7157 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
7158
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007159 Supported in default-server: No
7160
7161rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007162 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
7163 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
7164 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
7165
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007166 Supported in default-server: Yes
7167
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01007168send-proxy
7169 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
7170 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
7171 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
7172 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
7173 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
7174 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
7175 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
7176 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
7177 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
7178 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. See also the "accept-proxy"
7179 option of the "bind" keyword.
7180
7181 Supported in default-server: No
7182
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007183slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007184 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
7185 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
7186 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
7187 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
7188 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
7189 parameters :
7190
7191 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
7192 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
7193
7194 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
7195 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
7196 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
7197 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
7198
7199 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
7200 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
7201 seen as failed.
7202
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007203 Supported in default-server: Yes
7204
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007205source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007206source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007207source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007208 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
7209 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
7210 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
7211 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
7212
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007213 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
7214 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
7215 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
7216 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
7217 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
7218 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
7219 server.
7220
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007221 Supported in default-server: No
7222
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007223ssl
7224 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. At
7225 the moment, server certificates are not checked, so this is prone to man in
7226 the middle attacks. The real intended use is to permit SSL communication
7227 with software which cannot work in other modes over networks that would
7228 otherwise be considered safe enough for clear text communications.
7229
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007230track [<proxy>/]<server>
7231 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
7232 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
7233 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
7234 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
7235 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
7236
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007237 Supported in default-server: No
7238
7239weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007240 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
7241 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
7242 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02007243 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
7244 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
7245 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
7246 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
7247 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
7248 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007249
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007250 Supported in default-server: Yes
7251
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007252
72536. HTTP header manipulation
7254---------------------------
7255
7256In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
7257response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
7258request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
7259which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
7260against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
7261to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
7262passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
7263headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
7264never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
7265
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02007266There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
7267(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
7268rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
7269messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
7270in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007271happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02007272add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
7273normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
7274
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007275This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
7276in section 4.2 :
7277
7278 - reqadd <string>
7279 - reqallow <search>
7280 - reqiallow <search>
7281 - reqdel <search>
7282 - reqidel <search>
7283 - reqdeny <search>
7284 - reqideny <search>
7285 - reqpass <search>
7286 - reqipass <search>
7287 - reqrep <search> <replace>
7288 - reqirep <search> <replace>
7289 - reqtarpit <search>
7290 - reqitarpit <search>
7291 - rspadd <string>
7292 - rspdel <search>
7293 - rspidel <search>
7294 - rspdeny <search>
7295 - rspideny <search>
7296 - rsprep <search> <replace>
7297 - rspirep <search> <replace>
7298
7299With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
7300is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
7301parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
7302prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
7303Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
7304
7305 \t for a tab
7306 \r for a carriage return (CR)
7307 \n for a new line (LF)
7308 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
7309 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
7310 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
7311 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
7312 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
7313
7314The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
7315portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
7316above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
7317regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
73189 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
7319is very common to users of the "sed" program.
7320
7321The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
7322after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
7323
7324Notes related to these keywords :
7325---------------------------------
7326 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
7327 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
7328 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
7329
7330 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
7331 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
7332 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
7333
7334 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
7335 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
7336 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
7337 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
7338 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
7339
7340 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
7341 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
7342 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
7343 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
7344 useless headers before adding new ones.
7345
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007346 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007347 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
7348
7349 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
7350 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
7351 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
7352
7353 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
7354 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007355 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007356
7357
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010073587. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
7359------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007360
7361The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
7362content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
7363from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
7364simple :
7365
7366 - define test criteria with sets of values
7367 - perform actions only if a set of tests is valid
7368
7369The actions generally consist in blocking the request, or selecting a backend.
7370
7371In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
7372
7373 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
7374
7375This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
7376Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
7377and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
7378an operator which may be specified before the set of values. The values are
7379of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
7380
7381ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
7382'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
7383which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
7384
7385There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
7386performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
7387
7388The following ACL flags are currently supported :
7389
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007390 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
7391 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007392 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
7393
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007394The "-f" flag is special as it loads all of the lines it finds in the file
7395specified in argument and loads all of them before continuing. It is even
7396possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments if the patterns are to be loaded from
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02007397multiple files. Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will
7398be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs will be stripped. If it is absolutely
7399needed to insert a valid pattern beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a
7400space so that it is not taken for a comment. Depending on the data type and
7401match method, haproxy may load the lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast
7402lookups. This is true for IPv4 and exact string matching. In this case,
7403duplicates will automatically be removed. Also, note that the "-i" flag applies
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007404to subsequent entries and not to entries loaded from files preceding it. For
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02007405instance :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007406
7407 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
7408
7409In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
7410the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
7411case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
7412too.
7413
7414Note that right now it is difficult for the ACL parsers to report errors, so if
7415a file is unreadable or unparsable, the most you'll get is a parse error in the
7416ACL. Thus, file-based ACLs should only be produced by reliable processes.
7417
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007418Supported types of values are :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007419
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007420 - integers or integer ranges
7421 - strings
7422 - regular expressions
7423 - IP addresses and networks
7424
7425
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020074267.1. Matching integers
7427----------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007428
7429Matching integers is special in that ranges and operators are permitted. Note
7430that integer matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value
7431expressed with a lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which
7432may be omitted.
7433
7434For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
7435unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
7436representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
7437
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007438As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
7439two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
7440instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
7441ranges and operators.
7442
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007443For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007444operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
7445Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
7446of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007447
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007448Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007449
7450 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
7451 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
7452 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
7453 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
7454 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
7455
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007456For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007457
7458 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
7459
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007460This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
7461
7462 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
7463
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007464
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020074657.2. Matching strings
7466---------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007467
7468String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
7469exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
7470characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
7471string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
7472to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007473before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007474
7475
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020074767.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
7477-------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007478
7479Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
7480they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
7481possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
7482passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
7483the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007484the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
7485match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007486
7487
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020074887.4. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007489----------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007490
7491IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
7492netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
7493within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007494host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007495difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
7496at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
7497does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
7498parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007499
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007500IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
7501Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
7502trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
7503IPv6 patterns.
7504
7505HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
7506following situations :
7507 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
7508 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
7509 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
7510 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
7511 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
7512 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
7513 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
7514 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
7515 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
7516 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
7517
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007518
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020075197.5. Available matching criteria
7520--------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007521
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020075227.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
7523------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007524
7525A first set of criteria applies to information which does not require any
7526analysis of the request or response contents. Those generally include TCP/IP
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007527addresses and ports, as well as internal values independent on the stream.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007528
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007529always_false
7530 This one never matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7531 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7532
7533always_true
7534 This one always matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7535 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7536
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007537avg_queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007538avg_queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007539 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
7540 divided by the number of active servers. This is very similar to "queue"
7541 except that the size of the farm is considered, in order to give a more
7542 accurate measurement of the time it may take for a new connection to be
7543 processed. The main usage is to return a sorry page to new users when it
7544 becomes certain they will get a degraded service. Note that in the event
7545 there would not be any active server anymore, we would consider twice the
7546 number of queued connections as the measured value. This is a fair estimate,
7547 as we expect one server to get back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send
7548 new traffic to another backend if in better shape. See also the "queue",
7549 "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01007550
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007551be_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007552be_conn(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007553 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
7554 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
7555 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7556 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
7557 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007558
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01007559be_id <integer>
7560 Applies to the backend's id. Can be used in frontends to check from which
7561 backend it was called.
7562
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007563be_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007564be_sess_rate(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007565 Returns true when the sessions creation rate on the backend matches the
7566 specified values or ranges, in number of new sessions per second. This is
7567 used to switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one
7568 reaches too high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent
7569 sucking of an online dictionary).
7570
7571 Example :
7572 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
7573 backend dynamic
7574 mode http
7575 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
7576 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007577
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007578connslots <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007579connslots(<backend>) <integer>
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007580 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007581 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007582 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
7583
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007584 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
7585 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007586
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007587 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007588 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
7589 multiple backends (perhaps using acls to do name-based load balancing) and
7590 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
7591 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
7592 actually *down*, this acl is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007593 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007594
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007595 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
7596 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
7597 then this acl clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
7598 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007599
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007600dst <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007601 Applies to the local IPv4 or IPv6 address the client connected to. It can be
7602 used to switch to a different backend for some alternative addresses.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007603
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007604dst_conn <integer>
7605 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the same socket
7606 including the one being evaluated. It can be used to either return a sorry
7607 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
7608 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
7609 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
7610 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" criteria.
7611
7612dst_port <integer>
7613 Applies to the local port the client connected to. It can be used to switch
7614 to a different backend for some alternative ports.
7615
7616fe_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007617fe_conn(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007618 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
7619 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
7620 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7621 frontend. It can be used to either return a sorry page before hard-blocking,
7622 or to use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is
7623 considered saturated. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn" and "fe_sess_rate"
7624 criteria.
7625
7626fe_id <integer>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007627 Applies to the frontend's id. Can be used in backends to check from which
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007628 frontend it was called.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007629
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007630fe_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007631fe_sess_rate(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007632 Returns true when the session creation rate on the current or the named
7633 frontend matches the specified values or ranges, expressed in new sessions
7634 per second. This is used to limit the connection rate to acceptable ranges in
7635 order to prevent abuse of service at the earliest moment. This can be
7636 combined with layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for
7637 the rate to go down below the limit.
7638
7639 Example :
7640 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
7641 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
7642 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
7643 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
7644 frontend mail
7645 bind :25
7646 mode tcp
7647 maxconn 100
7648 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
7649 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
7650 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
7651 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007652
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007653nbsrv <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007654nbsrv(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007655 Returns true when the number of usable servers of either the current backend
7656 or the named backend matches the values or ranges specified. This is used to
7657 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
7658 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
7659 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007660
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007661queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007662queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007663 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
7664 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
7665 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
7666 one. This can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level,
7667 generally indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers.
7668 One possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones.
7669 See also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
7670
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007671sc1_bytes_in_rate
7672sc2_bytes_in_rate
7673 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
7674 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7675 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
7676
7677sc1_bytes_out_rate
7678sc2_bytes_out_rate
7679 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
7680 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7681 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
7682
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02007683sc1_clr_gpc0
7684sc2_clr_gpc0
7685 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
7686 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
7687 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. The test
7688 can also be used alone and always returns true. This is typically used as a
7689 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
7690 was verified :
7691
7692 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
7693 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
7694 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7695 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0 gt 5
7696 acl save sc1_clr_gpc0
7697 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
7698 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7699
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007700sc1_conn_cnt
7701sc2_conn_cnt
7702 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
7703 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
7704
7705sc1_conn_cur
7706sc2_conn_cur
7707 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
7708 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
7709 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
7710
7711sc1_conn_rate
7712sc2_conn_rate
7713 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
7714 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
7715 See also src_conn_rate.
7716
7717sc1_get_gpc0
7718sc2_get_gpc0
7719 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
7720 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
7721
7722sc1_http_err_cnt
7723sc2_http_err_cnt
7724 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
7725 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
7726 See also src_http_err_cnt.
7727
7728sc1_http_err_rate
7729sc2_http_err_rate
7730 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
7731 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
7732 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
7733 src_http_err_rate.
7734
7735sc1_http_req_cnt
7736sc2_http_req_cnt
7737 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
7738 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
7739 src_http_req_cnt.
7740
7741sc1_http_req_rate
7742sc2_http_req_rate
7743 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
7744 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
7745 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
7746 src_http_req_rate.
7747
7748sc1_inc_gpc0
7749sc2_inc_gpc0
7750 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
7751 tracked counters, and returns its value. Before the first invocation, the
7752 stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
7753 return 1. The test can also be used alone and always returns true. This is
7754 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
7755 when a first ACL was verified :
7756
7757 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7758 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0
7759 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7760
7761sc1_kbytes_in
7762sc2_kbytes_in
7763 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
7764 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
7765 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
7766 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
7767
7768sc1_kbytes_out
7769sc2_kbytes_out
7770 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
7771 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
7772 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
7773 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
7774
7775sc1_sess_cnt
7776sc2_sess_cnt
7777 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
7778 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
7779 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
7780 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007781 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007782 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
7783
7784sc1_sess_rate
7785sc2_sess_rate
7786 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
7787 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
7788 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
7789 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
7790 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007791 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007792
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007793so_id <integer>
7794 Applies to the socket's id. Useful in frontends with many bind keywords.
7795
7796src <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007797 Applies to the client's IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is usually used to limit
7798 access to certain resources such as statistics. Note that it is the TCP-level
7799 source address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a proxy.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007800
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007801src_bytes_in_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007802src_bytes_in_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007803 Returns the average bytes rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
7804 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7805 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007806 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007807
7808src_bytes_out_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007809src_bytes_out_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007810 Returns the average bytes rate to the connection's source IPv4 address in the
7811 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7812 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007813 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007814
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02007815src_clr_gpc0 <integer>
7816src_clr_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
7817 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
7818 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7819 stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not found, an
7820 entry is created and 0 is returned. The test can also be used alone and
7821 always returns true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression
7822 in order to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
7823
7824 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
7825 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
7826 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
7827 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
7828 acl save src_clr_gpc0
7829 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
7830 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7831
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007832src_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007833src_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007834 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
7835 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
7836 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007837 See also sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007838
7839src_conn_cur <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007840src_conn_cur(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007841 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
7842 current connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table
7843 or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007844 returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007845
7846src_conn_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007847src_conn_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007848 Returns the average connection rate from the connection's source IPv4 address
7849 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7850 in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007851 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007852
7853src_get_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007854src_get_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007855 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
7856 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
7857 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007858 See also sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007859
7860src_http_err_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007861src_http_err_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007862 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the current connection's
7863 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7864 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007865 If the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007866
7867src_http_err_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007868src_http_err_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007869 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the current connection's source
7870 IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
7871 table, measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table.
7872 This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007873 is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007874
7875src_http_req_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007876src_http_req_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007877 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the current connection's
7878 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7879 stick-table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007880 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007881
7882src_http_req_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007883src_http_req_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007884 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the current connection's
7885 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7886 stick-table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
7887 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007888 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007889
7890src_inc_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007891src_inc_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007892 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
7893 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7894 stick-table, and returns its value. If the address is not found, an entry is
7895 created and 1 is returned. The test can also be used alone and always returns
7896 true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to
7897 mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
7898
7899 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
7900 acl kill src_inc_gpc0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007901 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007902
7903src_kbytes_in <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007904src_kbytes_in(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007905 Returns the amount of data received from the connection's source IPv4 address
7906 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7907 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
7908 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007909 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007910
7911src_kbytes_out <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007912src_kbytes_out(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007913 Returns the amount of data sent to the connection's source IPv4 address in
7914 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7915 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
7916 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007917 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007918
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007919src_port <integer>
7920 Applies to the client's TCP source port. This has a very limited usage.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007921
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007922src_sess_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007923src_sess_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007924 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
7925 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
7926 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
7927 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007928 is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007929
7930src_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007931src_sess_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007932 Returns the average session rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
7933 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7934 amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A session is a
7935 connection that got past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007936 found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007937
7938src_updt_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007939src_updt_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007940 Creates or updates the entry associated to the source IPv4 address in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007941 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table. This table
7942 must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise the match
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007943 will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the expiration
7944 timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match can't return
7945 zero. This is used to reject service abusers based on their source address.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007946 Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-counters" instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007947
7948 Example :
7949 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
7950 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
7951 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
7952 listen ssh
7953 bind :22
7954 mode tcp
7955 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007956 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007957 tcp-request content reject if { src_update_count gt 3 }
7958 server local 127.0.0.1:22
7959
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007960srv_conn(<backend>/<server>) <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +02007961 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the server,
7962 possibly including the connection being evaluated.
7963 It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is full.
7964 See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" criteria.
7965
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01007966srv_id <integer>
7967 Applies to the server's id. Can be used in frontends or backends.
7968
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02007969srv_is_up(<server>)
7970srv_is_up(<backend>/<server>)
7971 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
7972 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
7973 looked up in the current backend. The function takes no arguments since it
7974 is used as a boolean. It is mainly used to take action based on an external
7975 status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's availability).
7976 Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in using dummy servers
7977 as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from the CLI, so that
7978 rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
7979
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02007980table_avl <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007981table_avl(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02007982 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
7983 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
7984
7985table_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007986table_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02007987 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
7988 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
7989 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
7990
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007991
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020079927.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4 (also called Layer 6)
7993---------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007994
7995A second set of criteria depends on data found in buffers, but which can change
7996during analysis. This requires that some data has been buffered, for instance
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007997through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request content"
7998keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007999
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008000is_ssl
8001 Returns true when the incoming connection was made via an SSL/TLS data layer
8002 and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared with
8003 a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
8004
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008005rep_ssl_hello_type <integer>
8006 Returns true when data in the response buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8007 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
8008 This test was designed to be used with TCP response content inspection: a
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008009 SSL session ID may be fetched. Note that this only applies to raw contents
8010 found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data
8011 layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008012
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008013req_len <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008014 Returns true when the length of the data in the request buffer matches the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008015 specified range. It is important to understand that this test does not
8016 return false as long as the buffer is changing. This means that a check with
8017 equality to zero will almost always immediately match at the beginning of the
8018 session, while a test for more data will wait for that data to come in and
8019 return false only when haproxy is certain that no more data will come in.
8020 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection.
8021
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02008022req_proto_http
8023 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
8024 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008025 is used so there should be no surprises. This test can be used for instance
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02008026 to direct HTTP traffic to a given port and HTTPS traffic to another one
8027 using TCP request content inspection rules.
8028
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008029req_rdp_cookie <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008030req_rdp_cookie(<name>) <string>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008031 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol, and
8032 a cookie is present and equal to <string>. By default, any cookie name is
8033 checked, but a specific cookie name can be specified in parenthesis. The
8034 parser only checks for the first cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol
8035 specification. The cookie name is case insensitive. This ACL can be useful
8036 with the "MSTS" cookie, as it can contain the user name of the client
8037 connecting to the server if properly configured on the client. This can be
8038 used to restrict access to certain servers to certain users.
8039
8040req_rdp_cookie_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008041req_rdp_cookie_cnt(<name>) <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008042 Returns true when the data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol
8043 and the number of RDP cookies matches the specified range (typically zero or
8044 one). Optionally a specific cookie name can be checked. This is a simple way
8045 of detecting the RDP protocol, as clients generally send the MSTS or MSTSHASH
8046 cookies.
8047
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008048req_ssl_hello_type <integer>
8049 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8050 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
8051 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection: an
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008052 SSL session ID may be fetched. Note that this only applies to raw contents
8053 found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data
8054 layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008055
8056req_ssl_sni <string>
8057 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8058 or superior) client hello message with a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8059 (SNI) matching <string>. SNI normally contains the name of the host the
8060 client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing
8061 or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This
8062 test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection. If content
8063 switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait for a complete client
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008064 hello (type 1), like in the example below. Note that this only applies to raw
8065 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
8066 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
8067 option. See also "ssl_sni" below.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008068
8069 Examples :
8070 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
8071 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8072 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
8073 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
8074 default_backend bk_sorry_page
8075
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008076req_ssl_ver <decimal>
8077 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like SSL, with a protocol
8078 version matching the specified range. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
8079 messages are supported. The test tries to be strict enough to avoid being
8080 easily fooled. In particular, it waits for as many bytes as announced in the
8081 message header if this header looks valid (bound to the buffer size). Note
8082 that TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. This test was designed to be used
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008083 with TCP request content inspection. Note that this only applies to raw
8084 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
8085 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
8086 option.
8087
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008088ssl_has_sni
8089 This is used to check for presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8090 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS data layer. Returns true
8091 when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires that
8092 the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions (check haproxy -vv).
8093
8094ssl_sni <string>
8095 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS data layer
8096 which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension sent by
8097 the client, matching the specified string. In HTTPS, the SNI field (when
8098 present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different from
8099 req_ssl_sni above in that it applies to the connection being deciphered by
8100 haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded. See also ssl_sni_end
8101 and ssl_sni_req below. This requires that the SSL library is build with
8102 support for TLS extensions (check haproxy -vv).
8103
8104ssl_sni_end <string>
8105 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS data layer
8106 which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension sent by
8107 the client, ending like the specified string. In HTTPS, the SNI field (when
8108 present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different from
8109 req_ssl_sni above in that it applies to the connection being deciphered by
8110 haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded. This requires that
8111 the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions (check haproxy -vv).
8112
8113ssl_sni_req <regex>
8114 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS data layer
8115 which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension sent by
8116 the client, matching the specified regex. In HTTPS, the SNI field (when
8117 present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different from
8118 req_ssl_sni above in that it applies to the connection being deciphered by
8119 haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded. This requires that
8120 the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008121
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02008122wait_end
8123 Waits for the end of the analysis period to return true. This may be used in
8124 conjunction with content analysis to avoid returning a wrong verdict early.
8125 It may also be used to delay some actions, such as a delayed reject for some
8126 special addresses. Since it either stops the rules evaluation or immediately
8127 returns true, it is recommended to use this acl as the last one in a rule.
8128 Please note that the default ACL "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior
8129 declaration. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
8130 inspection.
8131
8132 Examples :
8133 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
8134 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
8135 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
8136
8137 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
8138 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
8139 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
8140 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
8141 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
8142 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
8143 tcp-request content reject
8144
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008145
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020081467.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
8147--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008148
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008149A third set of criteria applies to information which can be found at the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008150application layer (layer 7). Those require that a full HTTP request has been
8151read, and are only evaluated then. They may require slightly more CPU resources
8152than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and response are indexed.
8153
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008154base <string>
8155 Returns true when the concatenation of the first Host header and the path
8156 part of the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the
8157 question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be used to match known
8158 files in virtual hosting environments, such as "www.example.com/favicon.ico".
8159 See also "path" and "uri".
8160
8161base_beg <string>
8162 Returns true when the base (see above) begins with one of the strings. This
8163 can be used to send certain directory names to alternative backends. See also
8164 "path_beg".
8165
8166base_dir <string>
8167 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8168 slashes in the base (see above). Probably of little use, see "url_dir" and
8169 "path_dir" instead.
8170
8171base_dom <string>
8172 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8173 in the base (see above). Probably of little use, see "path_dom" and "url_dom"
8174 instead.
8175
8176base_end <string>
8177 Returns true when the base (see above) ends with one of the strings. This may
8178 be used to control file name extension, though "path_end" is cheaper.
8179
8180base_len <integer>
8181 Returns true when the base (see above) length matches the values or ranges
8182 specified. This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8183
8184base_reg <regex>
8185 Returns true when the base (see above) matches one of the regular
8186 expressions. It can be used any time, but it is important to remember that
8187 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also "path_reg", "url_reg"
8188 and all "base_" criteria.
8189
8190base_sub <string>
8191 Returns true when the base (see above) contains one of the strings. It can be
8192 used to detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See
8193 also "base_dir".
8194
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02008195cook(<name>) <string>
8196 All "cook*" matching criteria inspect all "Cookie" headers to find a cookie
8197 with the name between parenthesis. If multiple occurrences of the cookie are
8198 found in the request, they will all be evaluated. Spaces around the name and
8199 the value are ignored as requested by the Cookie specification (RFC6265). The
8200 cookie name is case-sensitive. Use the scook() variant for response cookies
8201 sent by the server.
8202
8203 The "cook" criteria returns true if any of the request cookies <name> match
8204 any of the strings. This can be used to check exact for values. For instance,
8205 checking that the "profile" cookie is set to either "silver" or "gold" :
8206
8207 cook(profile) silver gold
8208
8209cook_beg(<name>) <string>
8210 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> begins with one of the
8211 strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8212 scook_beg() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8213
8214cook_cnt(<name>) <integer>
8215 Returns true when the number of occurrences of the specified cookie matches
8216 the values or ranges specified. This is used to detect presence, absence or
8217 abuse of a specific cookie. See "cook" for more information on header
8218 matching. Use the scook_cnt() variant for response cookies sent by the
8219 server.
8220
8221cook_dir(<name>) <string>
8222 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings
8223 either isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
8224 directory name matching, though it generally is of limited use with cookies.
8225 See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_dir()
8226 variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8227
8228cook_dom(<name>) <string>
8229 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings
8230 either isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name
8231 matching. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8232 scook_dom() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8233
8234cook_end(<name>) <string>
8235 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> ends with one of the
8236 strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8237 scook_end() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8238
8239cook_len(<name>) <integer>
8240 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> has a length which matches
8241 the values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
8242 cookie values. Note that an absent cookie does not match a zero-length test.
8243 See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_len()
8244 variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8245
8246cook_reg(<name>) <regex>
8247 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> matches any of the regular
8248 expressions. It can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that
8249 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also other "cook_" criteria,
8250 as well as "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8251 scook_reg() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8252
8253cook_sub(<name>) <string>
8254 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains at least one of
8255 the strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8256 scook_sub() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8257
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +02008258cook_val(<name>) <integer>
8259 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> starts with a number which
8260 matches the values or ranges specified. This may be used to select a server
8261 based on application-specific cookies. Note that an absent cookie does not
8262 match any value. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8263 scook_val() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8264
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008265hdr <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008266hdr(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008267 Note: all the "hdr*" matching criteria either apply to all headers, or to a
8268 particular header whose name is passed between parenthesis and without any
8269 space. The header name is not case-sensitive. The header matching complies
8270 with RFC2616, and treats as separate headers all values delimited by commas.
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008271 If an occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, only
8272 this occurrence will be considered. Positive values indicate a position from
8273 the first occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8274 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. Use the shdr()
8275 variant for response headers sent by the server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008276
8277 The "hdr" criteria returns true if any of the headers matching the criteria
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008278 match any of the strings. This can be used to check for exact values. For
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008279 instance, checking that "connection: close" is set :
8280
8281 hdr(Connection) -i close
8282
8283hdr_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008284hdr_beg(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008285 Returns true when one of the headers begins with one of the strings. See
8286 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_beg() variant for
8287 response headers sent by the server.
8288
8289hdr_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008290hdr_cnt(<header>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008291 Returns true when the number of occurrence of the specified header matches
8292 the values or ranges specified. It is important to remember that one header
8293 line may count as several headers if it has several values. This is used to
8294 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
8295 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
8296 of certain headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use
8297 the shdr_cnt() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8298
8299hdr_dir <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008300hdr_dir(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008301 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
8302 isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
8303 directory name matching, and may be used with Referer. See "hdr" for more
8304 information on header matching. Use the shdr_dir() variant for response
8305 headers sent by the server.
8306
8307hdr_dom <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008308hdr_dom(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008309 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
8310 isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name matching,
8311 and may be used with the Host header. See "hdr" for more information on
8312 header matching. Use the shdr_dom() variant for response headers sent by the
8313 server.
8314
8315hdr_end <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008316hdr_end(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008317 Returns true when one of the headers ends with one of the strings. See "hdr"
8318 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_end() variant for
8319 response headers sent by the server.
8320
8321hdr_ip <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008322hdr_ip(<header>[,<occ>]) <address>
8323 Returns true when one of the headers' values contains an IPv4 or IPv6 address
8324 matching <address>. This is mainly used with headers such as X-Forwarded-For
8325 or X-Client-IP. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008326 shdr_ip() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8327
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008328hdr_len <integer>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008329hdr_len(<header>[,<occ>]) <integer>
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008330 Returns true when at least one of the headers has a length which matches the
8331 values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
8332 headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
8333 shdr_len() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8334
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008335hdr_reg <regex>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008336hdr_reg(<header>[,<occ>]) <regex>
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02008337 Returns true it one of the headers matches one of the regular expressions. It
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008338 can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching
8339 is slower than other methods. See also other "hdr_" criteria, as well as
8340 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_reg() variant for
8341 response headers sent by the server.
8342
8343hdr_sub <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008344hdr_sub(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008345 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings. See "hdr"
8346 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_sub() variant for
8347 response headers sent by the server.
8348
8349hdr_val <integer>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008350hdr_val(<header>[,<occ>]) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008351 Returns true when one of the headers starts with a number which matches the
8352 values or ranges specified. This may be used to limit content-length to
8353 acceptable values for example. See "hdr" for more information on header
8354 matching. Use the shdr_val() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8355
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008356http_auth(<userlist>)
8357http_auth_group(<userlist>) <group> [<group>]*
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008358 Returns true when authentication data received from the client matches
8359 username & password stored on the userlist. It is also possible to
8360 use http_auth_group to check if the user is assigned to at least one
8361 of specified groups.
8362
8363 Currently only http basic auth is supported.
8364
Willy Tarreau85c27da2011-09-16 07:53:52 +02008365http_first_req
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +02008366 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
8367 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
8368 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or even to perform
8369 some specific ACL checks only on the first request.
8370
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008371method <string>
8372 Applies to the method in the HTTP request, eg: "GET". Some predefined ACL
8373 already check for most common methods.
8374
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008375path <string>
8376 Returns true when the path part of the request, which starts at the first
8377 slash and ends before the question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be
8378 used to match known files, such as /favicon.ico.
8379
8380path_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008381 Returns true when the path begins with one of the strings. This can be used
8382 to send certain directory names to alternative backends.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008383
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008384path_dir <string>
8385 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8386 slashes in the path. This is used to perform filename or directory name
8387 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
8388 "url_dir" and "path_sub".
8389
8390path_dom <string>
8391 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8392 in the path. This may be used to perform domain name matching in proxy
8393 requests. See also "path_sub" and "url_dom".
8394
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008395path_end <string>
8396 Returns true when the path ends with one of the strings. This may be used to
8397 control file name extension.
8398
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008399path_len <integer>
8400 Returns true when the path length matches the values or ranges specified.
8401 This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8402
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008403path_reg <regex>
8404 Returns true when the path matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
8405 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
8406 than other methods. See also "url_reg" and all "path_" criteria.
8407
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008408path_sub <string>
8409 Returns true when the path contains one of the strings. It can be used to
8410 detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See also
8411 "path_dir".
8412
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +02008413payload(<offset>,<length>) <string>
8414 Returns true if the block of <length> bytes, starting at byte <offset> in the
8415 request or response buffer (depending on the rule) exactly matches one of the
8416 strings.
8417
8418payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
8419 Returns true if the block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
8420 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
8421 the request or response buffer (depending on the rule) exactly matches one of
8422 the strings. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
8423 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
8424
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008425req_ver <string>
8426 Applies to the version string in the HTTP request, eg: "1.0". Some predefined
8427 ACL already check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
8428
8429status <integer>
8430 Applies to the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, eg: "302". It can be
8431 used to act on responses depending on status ranges, for instance, remove
8432 any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
8433
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008434url <string>
8435 Applies to the whole URL passed in the request. The only real use is to match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008436 "*", for which there already is a predefined ACL. See also "base".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008437
8438url_beg <string>
8439 Returns true when the URL begins with one of the strings. This can be used to
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008440 check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a protocol scheme. See also
8441 "base_beg".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008442
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008443url_dir <string>
8444 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8445 slashes in the URL. This is used to perform filename or directory name
8446 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
8447 "path_dir" and "url_sub".
8448
8449url_dom <string>
8450 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8451 in the URL. This is used to perform domain name matching without the risk of
8452 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "url_sub".
8453
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008454url_end <string>
8455 Returns true when the URL ends with one of the strings. It has very limited
8456 use. "path_end" should be used instead for filename matching.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008457
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008458url_ip <address>
8459 Applies to the IPv4 or IPv6 address specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP
8460 request. It can be used to prevent access to certain resources such as local
8461 network. It is useful with option "http_proxy".
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008462
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008463url_len <integer>
8464 Returns true when the url length matches the values or ranges specified. This
8465 may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8466
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008467url_port <integer>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008468 Applies to the port specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request. It can
8469 be used to prevent access to certain resources. It is useful with option
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008470 "http_proxy". Note that if the port is not specified in the request, port 80
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008471 is assumed.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008472
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008473url_reg <regex>
8474 Returns true when the URL matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
8475 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008476 than other methods. See also "base_reg", "path_reg" and all "url_" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008477
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008478url_sub <string>
8479 Returns true when the URL contains one of the strings. It can be used to
8480 detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See also "path_sub".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008481
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008482urlp(<name>) <string>
8483 Note: all "urlp*" matching criteria apply to the first occurrence of the
8484 parameter <name> in the query string. The parameter name is case-sensitive.
8485
8486 The "urlp" matching criteria returns true if the designated URL parameter
8487 matches any of the strings. This can be used to check for exact values.
8488
8489urlp_beg(<name>) <string>
8490 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" begins with one of the strings.
8491 This can be used to check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a
8492 protocol scheme.
8493
8494urlp_dir(<name>) <string>
8495 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains one of the strings
8496 either isolated or delimited with slashes. This is used to perform filename
8497 or directory name matching in a specific URL parameter without the risk of
8498 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "path_dir" and "urlp_sub".
8499
8500urlp_dom(<name>) <string>
8501 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8502 in the URL parameter "<name>". This is used to perform domain name matching
8503 in a specific URL parameter without the risk of wrong match due to colliding
8504 prefixes. See also "urlp_sub".
8505
8506urlp_end(<name>) <string>
8507 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" ends with one of the strings.
8508
8509urlp_ip(<name>) <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008510 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains an IPv4 or IPv6 address
8511 which matches one of the specified addresses.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008512
8513urlp_len(<name>) <integer>
8514 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" has a length matching the values
8515 or ranges specified. This is used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8516
8517urlp_reg(<name>) <regex>
8518 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" matches one of the regular
8519 expressions. It can be used any time, but it is important to remember that
8520 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also "path_reg" and all
8521 "urlp_" criteria.
8522
8523urlp_sub(<name>) <string>
8524 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains one of the strings. It
8525 can be used to detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See
8526 also "path_sub" and other "urlp_" criteria.
8527
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +02008528urlp_val(<name>) <integer>
8529 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" starts with a number matching
8530 the values or ranges specified. Note that the absence of the parameter does
8531 not match anything. Integers are unsigned so it is not possible to match
8532 negative data.
8533
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008534
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085357.6. Pre-defined ACLs
8536---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008537
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008538Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
8539every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02008540order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008541
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008542ACL name Equivalent to Usage
8543---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008544FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02008545HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008546HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
8547HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008548HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
8549HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
8550HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
8551HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
8552LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008553METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
8554METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
8555METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
8556METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
8557METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
8558METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008559RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008560REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008561TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008562WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
8563---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008564
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008565
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085667.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
8567----------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008568
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008569Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
8570combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008571
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008572 - AND (implicit)
8573 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
8574 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008575
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008576A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008577
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008578 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008579
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008580Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
8581indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008582
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008583For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
8584"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
8585requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
8586is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008587
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008588 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
8589 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
8590 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
8591 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008592
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008593To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
8594and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008595
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008596 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
8597 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
8598 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
8599 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008600
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008601 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
8602 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
8603 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
8604 use_backend www if host_www
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008605
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01008606It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
8607expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
8608be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008609the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01008610
8611 The following rule :
8612
8613 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
8614 block if METH_POST missing_cl
8615
8616 Can also be written that way :
8617
8618 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
8619
8620It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
8621to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
8622simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
8623sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
8624good use is the following :
8625
8626 With named ACLs :
8627
8628 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8629 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8630 monitor fail if site_dead
8631
8632 With anonymous ACLs :
8633
8634 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
8635
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008636See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008637
Willy Tarreau5764b382007-11-30 17:46:49 +01008638
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010086397.8. Pattern extraction
8640-----------------------
8641
8642The stickiness features relies on pattern extraction in the request and
8643response. Sometimes the data needs to be converted first before being stored,
8644for instance converted from ASCII to IP or upper case to lower case.
8645
8646All these operations of data extraction and conversion are defined as
8647"pattern extraction rules". A pattern rule always has the same format. It
8648begins with a single pattern fetch word, potentially followed by a list of
8649arguments within parenthesis then an optional list of transformations. As
8650much as possible, the pattern fetch functions use the same name as their
8651equivalent used in ACLs.
8652
8653The list of currently supported pattern fetch functions is the following :
8654
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008655 base This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the
8656 path part of the request, which starts at the first slash and
8657 ends before the question mark. It can be useful in virtual
8658 hosted environments to detect URL abuses as well as to improve
8659 shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size stick
8660 table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
8661 requested objects by host/path.
8662
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008663 src This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session.
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008664 It is of type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
8665 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
8666 according to RFC 4291.
8667
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008668 dst This is the destination IPv4 address of the session on the
8669 client side, which is the address the client connected to.
8670 It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008671 type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
8672 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
8673 according to RFC 4291.
8674
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008675 dst_port This is the destination TCP port of the session on the client
8676 side, which is the port the client connected to. This might be
8677 used when running in transparent mode or when assigning dynamic
8678 ports to some clients for a whole application session. It is of
8679 type integer and only works with such tables.
8680
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008681 hdr(<name>[,<occ>])
8682 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP
8683 request. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as
8684 a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
8685 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
8686 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the
8687 last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once
Willy Tarreaue428fb72011-12-16 21:50:30 +01008688 converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreau4a568972010-05-12 08:08:50 +02008689
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008690 is_ssl This checks the data layer used by incoming connection, and
8691 returns 1 if the connection was made via an SSL/TLS data layer,
8692 otherwise zero.
8693
Willy Tarreau6812bcf2012-04-29 09:28:50 +02008694 path This extracts the request's URL path (without the host part). A
8695 typical use is with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals
8696 which need to aggregate multiple information from databases and
8697 keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing caches, it would be
8698 wiser to use "url" instead.
8699
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008700 payload(<offset>,<length>)
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008701 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes, and starting
8702 at bytes <offset> in the buffer of request or response (request
8703 on "stick on" or "stick match" or response in on "stick store
8704 response").
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008705
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008706 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008707 This extracts a binary block. In a first step the size of the
8708 block is read from response or request buffer at <offset>
8709 bytes and considered coded on <length> bytes. In a second step
8710 data of the block are read from buffer at <offset2> bytes
8711 (by default <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize>).
8712 If <offset2> is prefixed by '+' or '-', it is relative to
8713 <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize> else it is absolute.
8714 Ex: see SSL session id example in "stick table" chapter.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008715
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008716 src_port This is the source TCP port of the session on the client side,
8717 which is the port the client connected from. It is very unlikely
8718 that this function will be useful but it's available at no cost.
8719 It is of type integer and only works with such tables.
8720
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008721 ssl_has_sni This checks the data layer used by incoming connection, and
8722 returns 1 if the connection was made via an SSL/TLS data layer
8723 and the client sent a Server Name Indication TLS extension,
8724 otherwise zero. This requires that the SSL library is build with
8725 support for TLS extensions (check haproxy -vv).
8726
8727 ssl_sni This extracts the Server Name Indication field from an incoming
8728 connection made via an SSL/TLS data layer and locally deciphered
8729 by haproxy. The result typically is a string matching the HTTPS
8730 host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have been
8731 built with support for TLS extensions (check haproxy -vv).
8732
Willy Tarreau6812bcf2012-04-29 09:28:50 +02008733 url This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A
8734 typical use is with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals
8735 which need to aggregate multiple information from databases and
8736 keep them in caches. See also "path".
8737
8738 url_ip This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the
8739 host part is presented as an IP address. Its use is very
8740 limited. For instance, a monitoring system might use this field
8741 as an alternative for the source IP in order to test what path a
8742 given source address would follow, or to force an entry in a
8743 table for a given source address.
8744
8745 url_port This extracts the port part from the request's URL. It probably
8746 is totally useless but it was available at no cost.
8747
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008748 url_param(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008749 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in
8750 the query string of the request and uses the corresponding value
8751 to match. A typical use is to get sticky session through url
8752 (e.g. http://example.com/foo?JESSIONID=some_id with
8753 url_param(JSESSIONID)), for cases where cookies cannot be used.
David Cournapeau16023ee2010-12-23 20:55:41 +09008754
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008755 rdp_cookie(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008756 This extracts the value of the rdp cookie <name> as a string
8757 and uses this value to match. This enables implementation of
8758 persistence based on the mstshash cookie. This is typically
8759 done if there is no msts cookie present.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008760
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008761 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing
8762 algorithm may be used and thus the distribution of clients
8763 to backend servers is not linked to a hash of the RDP
8764 cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
8765 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconnect" will
8766 lead to a more even distribution of clients to backend
8767 servers than the hash used by "balance rdp-cookie".
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008768
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008769 Example :
8770 listen tse-farm
8771 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
8772 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
8773 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8774 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
8775 # apply RDP cookie persistence
8776 persist rdp-cookie
8777 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
8778 # This is only useful makes sense if
8779 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
8780 stick-table type string size 204800
8781 stick on rdp_cookie(mstshash)
8782 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
8783 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008784
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008785 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie",
8786 "tcp-request" and the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008787
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008788 cookie(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008789 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
Willy Tarreau28376d62012-04-26 21:26:10 +02008790 "Cookie" header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header
8791 from the response, and uses the corresponding value to match. A
8792 typical use is to get multiple clients sharing a same profile
8793 use the same server. This can be similar to what "appsession"
8794 does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
8795 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02008796
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008797 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02008798
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008799 set-cookie(<name>)
Willy Tarreau28376d62012-04-26 21:26:10 +02008800 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the
8801 "cookie" fetch which is capable of handling both requests and
8802 responses. This keyword will disappear soon.
8803
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008804 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
8805 "Set-Cookie" header line from the response and uses the
8806 corresponding value to match. This can be comparable to what
8807 "appsession" does with default options, but with support for
8808 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02008809
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008810 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02008811
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008812
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008813The currently available list of transformations include :
8814
8815 lower Convert a string pattern to lower case. This can only be placed
8816 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
8817 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
8818
8819 upper Convert a string pattern to upper case. This can only be placed
8820 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
8821 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
8822
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008823 ipmask(<mask>) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups
Willy Tarreaud31d6eb2010-01-26 18:01:41 +01008824 and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within a
8825 certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
8826 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
8827 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
8828
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008829
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020088308. Logging
8831----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008832
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008833One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
8834provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
8835very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
8836provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
8837state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008838to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008839headers.
8840
8841In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
8842about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
8843send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
8844
8845 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
8846 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
8847 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
8848 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
8849 at the termination.
8850
8851The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
8852allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
8853as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
8854while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
8855real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
8856delay.
8857
8858
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020088598.1. Log levels
8860---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008861
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008862TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008863source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008864HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
8865in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
8866track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
8867syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
8868about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008869
8870
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020088718.2. Log formats
8872----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008873
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008874HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008875and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
8876slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
8877options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008878
8879 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
8880 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
8881 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
8882 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
8883 extents.
8884
8885 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
8886 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
8887 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
8888 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
8889 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
8890
8891 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
8892 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
8893 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
8894 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
8895 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
8896
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008897 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
8898 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
8899 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
8900 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
8901
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008902 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
8903
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008904Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
8905specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
8906field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
8907servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
8908always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
8909identifier.
8910
8911Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
8912 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
8913 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
8914 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
8915 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
8916
8917
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020089188.2.1. Default log format
8919-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008920
8921This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
8922as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
8923format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
8924
8925 Example :
8926 listen www
8927 mode http
8928 log global
8929 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
8930
8931 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
8932 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
8933 (www/HTTP)
8934
8935 Field Format Extract from the example above
8936 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
8937 2 'Connect from' Connect from
8938 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
8939 4 'to' to
8940 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
8941 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
8942
8943Detailed fields description :
8944 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
8945 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
8946 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
8947 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
8948 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
8949 and processed the connection.
8950 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
8951
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008952In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
8953"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
8954connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
8955
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008956It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
8957will eventually disappear.
8958
8959
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020089608.2.2. TCP log format
8961---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008962
8963The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
8964is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
8965information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
8966counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
8967emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
8968environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
8969the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
8970sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008971specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
8972not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
8973fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
8974marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008975
8976 Example :
8977 frontend fnt
8978 mode tcp
8979 option tcplog
8980 log global
8981 default_backend bck
8982
8983 backend bck
8984 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
8985
8986 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
8987 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
8988 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
8989
8990 Field Format Extract from the example above
8991 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
8992 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
8993 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
8994 4 frontend_name fnt
8995 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
8996 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
8997 7 bytes_read* 212
8998 8 termination_state --
8999 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
9000 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
9001
9002Detailed fields description :
9003 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009004 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
9005 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
9006 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
9007 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
9008 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009009
9010 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009011 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
9012 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
9013 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009014
9015 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
9016 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
9017 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
9018 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
9019
9020 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
9021 and processed the connection.
9022
9023 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
9024 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
9025 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
9026 applications.
9027
9028 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
9029 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
9030 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
9031 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
9032 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
9033
9034 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
9035 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
9036 See "Timers" below for more details.
9037
9038 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
9039 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
9040 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
9041 "Timers" below for more details.
9042
9043 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
9044 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
9045 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
9046 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
9047 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
9048 details.
9049
9050 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
9051 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
9052 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
9053 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
9054 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
9055
9056 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
9057 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
9058 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
9059 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
9060 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
9061 for more details.
9062
9063 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009064 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009065 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
9066 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
9067 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009068 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009069
9070 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
9071 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
9072 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
9073 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
9074 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
9075 caused by a denial of service attack.
9076
9077 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
9078 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
9079 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
9080 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
9081 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
9082 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
9083 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
9084 denial of service attack.
9085
9086 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
9087 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
9088 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
9089 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
9090 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
9091 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
9092 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
9093 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
9094 be processed than on other servers.
9095
9096 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
9097 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
9098 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
9099 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
9100 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
9101 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
9102 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
9103 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
9104 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
9105 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
9106 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
9107 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
9108 should not be attributed to the logged server.
9109
9110 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9111 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
9112 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
9113 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
9114 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
9115 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
9116 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
9117 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
9118
9119 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9120 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
9121 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
9122 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
9123 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
9124 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
9125 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
9126 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
9127 occurs.
9128
9129
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020091308.2.3. HTTP log format
9131----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009132
9133The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
9134is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
9135the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
9136are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
9137emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
9138generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
9139"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
9140which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009141frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
9142is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009143
9144Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
9145slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
9146with a star ('*') after the field name below.
9147
9148 Example :
9149 frontend http-in
9150 mode http
9151 option httplog
9152 log global
9153 default_backend bck
9154
9155 backend static
9156 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
9157
9158 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9159 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9160 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009161 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009162
9163 Field Format Extract from the example above
9164 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
9165 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
9166 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
9167 4 frontend_name http-in
9168 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
9169 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
9170 7 status_code 200
9171 8 bytes_read* 2750
9172 9 captured_request_cookie -
9173 10 captured_response_cookie -
9174 11 termination_state ----
9175 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
9176 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
9177 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
9178 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
9179 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009180
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009181
9182Detailed fields description :
9183 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009184 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
9185 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
9186 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
9187 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
9188 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009189
9190 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009191 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
9192 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
9193 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009194
9195 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
9196 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
9197 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
9198 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
9199 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
9200
9201 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
9202 and processed the connection.
9203
9204 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
9205 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
9206 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
9207
9208 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
9209 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
9210 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
9211 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
9212 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
9213 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
9214
9215 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
9216 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
9217 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
9218 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
9219 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
9220 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
9221
9222 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
9223 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
9224 See "Timers" below for more details.
9225
9226 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
9227 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
9228 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
9229 below for more details.
9230
9231 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
9232 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
9233 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
9234 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
9235 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
9236 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
9237 for more details.
9238
9239 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
9240 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
9241 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
9242 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
9243 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
9244 details.
9245
9246 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
9247 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
9248 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
9249
9250 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
9251 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
9252 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
9253 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
9254 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
9255 overflowing.
9256
9257 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
9258 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
9259 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
9260 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
9261 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
9262 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
9263 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
9264 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
9265
9266 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
9267 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
9268 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
9269 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
9270 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
9271 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
9272 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
9273 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
9274
9275 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
9276 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
9277 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
9278 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
9279 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
9280 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
9281 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
9282
9283 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009284 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009285 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
9286 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
9287 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009288 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009289 system.
9290
9291 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
9292 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
9293 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
9294 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
9295 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
9296 caused by a denial of service attack.
9297
9298 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
9299 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
9300 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
9301 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
9302 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
9303 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
9304 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
9305 denial of service attack.
9306
9307 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
9308 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
9309 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
9310 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
9311 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
9312 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
9313 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
9314 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
9315 processed than on other servers.
9316
9317 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
9318 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
9319 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
9320 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
9321 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
9322 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
9323 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
9324 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
9325 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
9326 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
9327 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
9328 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
9329 should not be attributed to the logged server.
9330
9331 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9332 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
9333 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
9334 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
9335 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
9336 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
9337 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
9338 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
9339
9340 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9341 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
9342 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
9343 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
9344 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
9345 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
9346 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
9347 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
9348 occurs.
9349
9350 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
9351 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
9352 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
9353 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
9354 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
9355 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
9356 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
9357 cookies" below for more details.
9358
9359 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
9360 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
9361 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
9362 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
9363 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
9364 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
9365 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
9366 and cookies" below for more details.
9367
9368 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
9369 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
9370 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
9371 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
9372 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
9373 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
9374 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
9375 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
9376
9377
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020093788.2.4. Custom log format
9379------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009380
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009381The directive log-format allows you to custom the logs in http mode and tcp
9382mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009383
9384HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
9385Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
9386separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
9387prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
9388
9389Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
9390variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
9391string formats ("Q").
9392
9393Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
9394HAproxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
9395
9396Flags are :
9397 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009398 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009399
9400 Example:
9401
9402 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
9403 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
9404
9405At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
9406
9407 log-format %Ci:%Cp\ [%t]\ %f\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %st\ %B\ %cc\ \
Willy Tarreau6580c062012-03-12 15:09:42 +01009408 %cs\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009409
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009410the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009411
9412 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}Ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %st\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %Cp\ \
Willy Tarreau6580c062012-03-12 15:09:42 +01009413 %ms\ %f\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009414 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %cc\ %cs\ \%hrl\ %hsl
9415
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009416and the default TCP format is defined this way :
9417
9418 log-format %Ci:%Cp\ [%t]\ %f\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
9419 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
9420
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009421Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
9422
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009423 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
9424 | H | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
9425 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
9426 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
9427 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
9428 | | %B | bytes_read | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009429 | | %Ci | client_ip | IP |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009430 | | %Cp | client_port | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009431 | | %Bi | backend_source_ip | IP |
William Lallemandb7ff6a32012-03-02 14:35:21 +01009432 | | %Bp | backend_source_port | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009433 | | %Fi | frontend_ip | IP |
9434 | | %Fp | frontend_port | numeric |
9435 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009436 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009437 | | %Si | server_IP | IP |
9438 | | %Sp | server_port | numeric |
9439 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009440 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
9441 | * | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
9442 | * | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009443 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009444 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
9445 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
9446 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
9447 | | %b | backend_name | string |
9448 | | %bc | beconn | numeric |
9449 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
9450 | * | %cc | captured_request_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009451 | * | %rt | http_request_counter | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009452 | * | %cs | captured_response_cookie | string |
9453 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
9454 | | %fc | feconn | numeric |
9455 | * | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
9456 | * | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
9457 | * | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
9458 | * | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
9459 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009460 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009461 | * | %r | http_request | string |
9462 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
9463 | | %s | server_name | string |
9464 | | %sc | srv_conn | numeric |
9465 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
9466 | * | %st | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009467 | | %t | date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009468 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreau6580c062012-03-12 15:09:42 +01009469 | * | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009470 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009471
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009472*: mode http only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009473
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094748.3. Advanced logging options
9475-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009476
9477Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
9478just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
9479options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
9480for more information about their usage.
9481
9482
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094838.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
9484------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009485
9486It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
9487haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
9488commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
9489monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
9490ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
9491
9492 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
9493 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
9494 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
9495 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
9496
9497 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
9498 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
9499 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
9500 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
9501 such as other load-balancers.
9502
9503 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
9504 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
9505 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
9506
9507
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095088.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
9509----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009510
9511The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
9512what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
9513or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
9514"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
9515just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
9516log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
9517after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
9518is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
9519with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
9520with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
9521
9522
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095238.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
9524------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009525
9526Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
9527for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
9528"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
9529retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
9530raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
9531a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
9532file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
9533you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
9534"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
9535
9536
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095378.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
9538--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009539
9540Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
9541multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
9542them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
9543"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
9544logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
9545error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
9546and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
9547too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
9548useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
9549alternative.
9550
9551
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095528.4. Timing events
9553------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009554
9555Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
9556reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
9557the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
9558frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
9559mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
9560
9561 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
9562 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
9563 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
9564 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
9565 the client closes prematurely or times out.
9566
9567 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
9568 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
9569 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
9570 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
9571 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
9572
9573 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
9574 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
9575 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
9576 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
9577 connection never established.
9578
9579 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
9580 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
9581 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
9582 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
9583 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
9584 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
9585 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
9586 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
9587 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
9588 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
9589 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
9590
9591 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
9592 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
9593 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
9594 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
9595 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
9596
9597 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
9598
9599 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
9600 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
9601 negative.
9602
9603These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
9604protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
9605that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009606due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009607close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
9608session has been aborted on timeout.
9609
9610Most common cases :
9611
9612 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
9613 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
9614 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
9615 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
9616 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
9617 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
9618 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
9619 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
9620 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +02009621 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
9622 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
9623 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009624
9625 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
9626 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
9627 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
9628 of ms on remote networks.
9629
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009630 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
9631 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
9632 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009633
9634 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
9635 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
9636 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
9637 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
9638 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
9639 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
9640 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
9641 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
9642 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
9643 to the server until another one is released.
9644
9645Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
9646
9647 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
9648 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
9649 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
9650
9651 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
9652 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
9653 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
9654
9655 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
9656 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
9657 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
9658 flags.
9659
9660 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
9661 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
9662 Check the session termination flags, then check the
9663 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
9664 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
9665 the client connection was maintained open.
9666
9667 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
9668 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
9669 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
9670 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
9671
9672
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020096738.5. Session state at disconnection
9674-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009675
9676TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
9677"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
96782-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
9679each of which has a special meaning :
9680
9681 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
9682 session to terminate :
9683
9684 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
9685
9686 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
9687 server explicitly refused it.
9688
9689 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
9690 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
9691 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
9692 error in server response which might have caused information leak
9693 (eg: cacheable cookie), or because the response was processed by
9694 the proxy (redirect, stats, etc...).
9695
9696 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
9697 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
9698 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
9699 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
9700 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
9701
9702 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
9703 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
9704 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
9705 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
9706 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
9707
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +09009708 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
9709 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
9710
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009711 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
9712 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
9713 backup connections when going up.
9714
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +02009715 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
9716
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009717 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
9718 send or receive data.
9719
9720 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
9721 send or receive data.
9722
9723 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
9724 with nothing left in the buffers.
9725
9726 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
9727
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01009728 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009729 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
9730
9731 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
9732 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
9733 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
9734 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
9735 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
9736
9737 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
9738 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
9739
9740 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
9741 server (HTTP only).
9742
9743 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
9744
9745 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
9746 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
9747 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
9748
9749 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
9750 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
9751 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
9752
9753 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
9754
9755 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
9756 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
9757
9758 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
9759 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
9760 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
9761
9762 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
9763 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02009764 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
9765 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009766
9767 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
9768 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
9769 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
9770 another server.
9771
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009772 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009773 server.
9774
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009775 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
9776 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
9777 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
9778 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
9779
9780 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
9781 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
9782 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
9783 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
9784
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +02009785 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
9786 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
9787 "use-server" rule).
9788
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009789 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
9790
9791 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
9792 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
9793
9794 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
9795
9796 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
9797 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
9798 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
9799
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009800 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
9801 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
9802 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
9803 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
9804 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
9805
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009806 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
9807
9808 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
9809 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
9810
9811 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
9812
9813 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
9814
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009815The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
9816was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009817helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
9818starvation, attacks, etc...
9819
9820The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
9821alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
9822easier finding and understanding.
9823
9824 Flags Reason
9825
9826 -- Normal termination.
9827
9828 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
9829 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
9830 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
9831 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
9832
9833 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
9834 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
9835 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
9836 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
9837 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
9838 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009839
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009840 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
9841 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009842 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009843
9844 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
9845 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
9846 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
9847
9848 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
9849 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
9850 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
9851 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
9852 the server takes too long to respond.
9853
9854 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
9855 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
9856 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
9857 long a time to respond.
9858
9859 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
9860 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
9861 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
9862 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
9863 and the client.
9864
9865 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
9866 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
9867 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
9868 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
9869 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
9870 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
9871
9872 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
9873 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009874 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
9875 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
9876 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
9877 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009878
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009879 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009880 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
9881 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
9882 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
9883 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
9884 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
9885
9886 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
9887 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
9888 503 or 504 here.
9889
9890 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
9891 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
9892 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
9893 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
9894 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
9895
9896 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
9897 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009898 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009899 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
9900 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
9901
9902 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
9903 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
9904 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
9905 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
9906 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
9907 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
9908 between haproxy and the server.
9909
9910 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
9911 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
9912 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
9913 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
9914 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
9915 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
9916 solution is to fix the application.
9917
9918 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
9919 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
9920 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
9921 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
9922 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
9923 external attacks.
9924
9925 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
9926 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009927 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009928 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
9929 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
9930
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +01009931 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
9932 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
9933 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
9934 the client.
9935
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009936 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
9937 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
9938 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
9939 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +01009940 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
9941 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
9942 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
9943 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
9944 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009945
9946 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
9947 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
9948 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
9949 returned an HTTP 403 error.
9950
9951 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
9952 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
9953 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
9954 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
9955
9956 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
9957 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
9958 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
9959 only be solved by proper system tuning.
9960
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009961The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
9962persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
9963important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
9964re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
9965
9966 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
9967
9968 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
9969 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
9970 set on a GET request.
9971
9972 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
9973 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009974 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009975 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
9976
9977 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
9978 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
9979 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
9980
9981 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
9982 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
9983 already got a cookie.
9984
9985 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
9986 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
9987 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
9988 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
9989 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
9990
9991 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
9992 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
9993 new cookie was inserted in the response.
9994
9995 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
9996 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
9997 new cookie was inserted in the response.
9998
9999 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
10000 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
10001
10002 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
10003 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
10004 then advertised in the response.
10005
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010006
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200100078.6. Non-printable characters
10008-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010009
10010In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
10011consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
10012converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
10013prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
10014being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
10015escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
10016is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
10017'}' when logging headers.
10018
10019Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
10020issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
10021containing spaces is "User-Agent".
10022
10023Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
10024the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
10025performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
10026
10027
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200100288.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
10029---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010030
10031Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
10032achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010033section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010034cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
10035the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
10036the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010037locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010038not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
10039user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
10040a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
10041wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
10042
10043 Examples :
10044 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
10045 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
10046
10047 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
10048 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
10049
10050
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200100518.8. Capturing HTTP headers
10052---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010053
10054Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
10055proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
10056the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
10057server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
10058
10059Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
10060response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010061section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010062
10063It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010064time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
10065appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010066are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
10067and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
10068follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
10069request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
10070in the logs.
10071
10072 Example :
10073 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
10074 listen proxy-out
10075 mode http
10076 option httplog
10077 option logasap
10078 log global
10079 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
10080
10081 # log the name of the virtual server
10082 capture request header Host len 20
10083
10084 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
10085 capture request header Content-Length len 10
10086
10087 # log the beginning of the referrer
10088 capture request header Referer len 20
10089
10090 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
10091 capture response header Server len 20
10092
10093 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
10094 capture response header Content-Length len 10
10095
10096 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
10097 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
10098
10099 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
10100 capture response header Via len 20
10101
10102 # log the URL location during a redirection
10103 capture response header Location len 20
10104
10105 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
10106 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
10107 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
10108 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
10109 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
10110
10111 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
10112 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
10113 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
10114 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010115 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010116
10117 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
10118 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
10119 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
10120 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
10121 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010122 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010123
10124
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200101258.9. Examples of logs
10126---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010127
10128These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
10129them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
10130reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
10131
10132 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
10133 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
10134 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
10135
10136 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
10137 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
10138
10139 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
10140 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
10141 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
10142
10143 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
10144 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
10145
10146 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
10147 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
10148 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
10149
10150 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010151 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010152 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
10153 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
10154
10155 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
10156 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
10157 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
10158
10159 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
10160 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010161 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010162 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
10163 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
10164 to return the 502 and not the server.
10165
10166 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010167 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010168
10169 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
10170 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
10171 Nothing was sent to any server.
10172
10173 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
10174 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
10175
10176 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
10177 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
10178 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
10179 send a 408 return code to the client.
10180
10181 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
10182 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
10183
10184 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
10185 5 seconds ("c----").
10186
10187 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
10188 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010189 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010190
10191 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010192 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010193 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
10194 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
10195 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
10196 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
10197 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010198
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010199
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200102009. Statistics and monitoring
10201----------------------------
10202
10203It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
10204mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
10205CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
10206Unix socket.
10207
10208
102099.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010210---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010211
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010010212The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
10213page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
10214
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010215 0. pxname: proxy name
10216 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
10217 for server)
10218 2. qcur: current queued requests
10219 3. qmax: max queued requests
10220 4. scur: current sessions
10221 5. smax: max sessions
10222 6. slim: sessions limit
10223 7. stot: total sessions
10224 8. bin: bytes in
10225 9. bout: bytes out
10226 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010227 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010228 12. ereq: request errors
10229 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010010230 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010231 15. wretr: retries (warning)
10232 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +010010233 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010234 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
10235 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
10236 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
10237 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
10238 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
10239 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
10240 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
10241 25. qlimit: queue limit
10242 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
10243 27. iid: unique proxy id
10244 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
10245 29. throttle: warm up status
10246 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
10247 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020010248 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +020010249 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
10250 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
10251 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020010252 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010010253 UNK -> unknown
10254 INI -> initializing
10255 SOCKERR -> socket error
10256 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
10257 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
10258 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
10259 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
10260 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
10261 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
10262 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
10263 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
10264 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
10265 disable-on-404
10266 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
10267 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
10268 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020010269 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
10270 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010271 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
10272 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
10273 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
10274 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
10275 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
10276 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010277 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
10278 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
10279 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
10280 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010010281 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
10282 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010283
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010284
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200102859.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010286-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010287
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010288The following commands are supported on the UNIX stats socket ; all of them
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010289must be terminated by a line feed. The socket supports pipelining, so that it
10290is possible to chain multiple commands at once provided they are delimited by
10291a semi-colon or a line feed, although the former is more reliable as it has no
10292risk of being truncated over the network. The responses themselves will each be
10293followed by an empty line, so it will be easy for an external script to match a
10294given response with a given request. By default one command line is processed
10295then the connection closes, but there is an interactive allowing multiple lines
10296to be issued one at a time.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010297
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010298It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
10299on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
10300own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010301
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010302clear counters
10303 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
10304 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
10305 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
10306 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
10307 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
10308
10309clear counters all
10310 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
10311 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
10312 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
10313
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090010314clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
10315 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
10316
10317 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
10318 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
10319 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
10320 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
10321 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
10322 later after the session ends is usual enough.
10323
10324 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
10325
10326 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
10327 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
10328 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
10329 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
10330 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
10331 the ACLs :
10332
10333 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
10334 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
10335 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
10336 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
10337 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
10338 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
10339
10340 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090010341 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
10342 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010343
10344 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010345 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010346 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010347 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
10348 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
10349 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10350 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010351
10352 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
10353
10354 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010355 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010356 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10357 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090010358 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
10359 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
10360 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010361
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020010362disable frontend <frontend>
10363 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
10364 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
10365 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
10366 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
10367 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
10368 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
10369 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
10370 on the stats page.
10371
10372 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
10373 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
10374
10375 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10376 level "admin".
10377
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010378disable server <backend>/<server>
10379 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
10380 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
10381 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
10382 during the maintenance.
10383
10384 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
10385 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
10386
10387 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020010388 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010389
10390 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10391 level "admin".
10392
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020010393enable frontend <frontend>
10394 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
10395 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
10396 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
10397 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
10398 which was disabled.
10399
10400 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
10401 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
10402
10403 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10404 level "admin".
10405
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010406enable server <backend>/<server>
10407 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
10408 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
10409
10410 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020010411 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010412
10413 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10414 level "admin".
10415
10416get weight <backend>/<server>
10417 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
10418 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
10419 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
10420 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
10421 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020010422 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010423
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010424help
10425 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
10426 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010427
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010428prompt
10429 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
10430 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
10431 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
10432 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
10433 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
10434 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
10435 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
10436 command.
10437
10438quit
10439 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010440
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020010441set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
10442 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any non-null
10443 positive value is allowed, but setting values larger than the global maxconn
10444 does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections were
10445 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
10446 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
10447 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
10448 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
10449
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020010450set maxconn global <maxconn>
10451 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
10452 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
10453 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
10454 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
10455 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
10456 setting.
10457
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020010458set rate-limit connections global <value>
10459 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
10460 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
10461 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
10462 is passed in number of connections per second.
10463
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020010464set table <table> key <key> data.<data_type> <value>
10465 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
10466 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
10467 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
10468 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
10469 IP address or affect its quality of service.
10470
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010471set timeout cli <delay>
10472 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
10473 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
10474 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
10475
10476set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
10477 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
10478 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
10479 configured weight. Relative weights are only permitted between 0 and 100%,
10480 and absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256. Servers which are part
10481 of a farm running a static load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations
10482 because the weight cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only
10483 accepted values are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take
10484 effect immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
10485 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to disable
10486 a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to enable it
10487 again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command is restricted
10488 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin". Both the
10489 backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by their
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020010490 numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010491
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010010492show errors [<iid>]
10493 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
10494 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020010495 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
10496 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
10497 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010010498
10499 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
10500 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
10501 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
10502 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
10503 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
10504 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
10505 are reported too.
10506
10507 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
10508 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
10509 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
10510 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
10511 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
10512 code.
10513
10514 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
10515 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
10516 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
10517 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
10518 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
10519 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
10520 line.
10521
10522 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010523 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
10524 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010010525 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
10526 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
10527
10528 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
10529 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
10530 00038 Location: blah\r\n
10531 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
10532 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
10533 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
10534 00204+ minal\r\n
10535 00211 \r\n
10536
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010537 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010010538 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
10539 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
10540 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
10541 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
10542 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
10543 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010544
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010545show info
10546 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
10547
10548show sess
10549 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020010550 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
10551 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
10552
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010010553show sess <id>
10554 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
10555 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
10556 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
10557 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
10558 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
10559 freely evolve depending on demands.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010560
10561show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
10562 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
10563 possible to dump only selected items :
10564 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
10565 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
10566 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
10567 for example:
10568 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
10569 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
10570 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
10571
10572 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010573 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
10574 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010575 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
10576 Release_date: 2009/09/23
10577 Nbproc: 1
10578 Process_num: 1
10579 (...)
10580
10581 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
10582 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
10583 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
10584 (...)
10585 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
10586
10587 $
10588
10589 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
10590 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
10591 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
10592 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010593 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010594
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010595show table
10596 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
10597 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
10598 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
10599 entries currently in use.
10600
10601 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010602 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010603 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
10604 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010605
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010606show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010607 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
10608 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
10609 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010610 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
10611
10612 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
10613 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
10614 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
10615 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
10616 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
10617
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010618 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
10619 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
10620 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
10621 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
10622 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
10623 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
10624
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090010625
10626 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090010627 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
10628 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010629
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010630 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010631 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010632 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010633 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
10634 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
10635 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10636 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010637
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010638 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010639 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010640 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10641 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010642
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010643 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
10644 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010645 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010646 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10647 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010648
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010649 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
10650 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010651 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010652 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10653 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
10654
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010655 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
10656 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
10657 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
10658 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
10659 time goes, the average event rate drops.
10660
10661 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
10662 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
10663 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010664 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
10665 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010666 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
10667 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020010668
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020010669shutdown frontend <frontend>
10670 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
10671 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
10672 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
10673 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
10674 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
10675 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
10676 once it is terminated.
10677
10678 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
10679 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
10680
10681 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10682 level "admin".
10683
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020010684shutdown session <id>
10685 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
10686 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
10687 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
10688 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
10689 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
10690 flag in the logs.
10691
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020010692shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
10693 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
10694 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
10695 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
10696 'K' flag in the logs.
10697
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010698/*
10699 * Local variables:
10700 * fill-column: 79
10701 * End:
10702 */